xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 1a9239bb4253f9076b5b4b2a1a4e8d7defd77a95)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2025 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80  *	channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85  *	is not permitted.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96  *	restrictions.
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113  *	on this channel.
114  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118  *	restrictions.
119  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
121  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
122  *	not permitted using this channel
123  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
124  *	not permitted using this channel
125  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
126  *	mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
127  *	even if it is otherwise disabled.
128  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation
129  *	with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
130  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity on a 20 MHz channel,
131  *	even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
132  */
133 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED			= BIT(0),
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR			= BIT(1),
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD			= BIT(2),
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR			= BIT(3),
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS		= BIT(4),
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS		= BIT(5),
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM			= BIT(6),
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ			= BIT(7),
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ		= BIT(8),
143 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY		= BIT(9),
144 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT		= BIT(10),
145 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ			= BIT(11),
146 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ			= BIT(12),
147 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE			= BIT(13),
148 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ			= BIT(14),
149 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ			= BIT(15),
150 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ			= BIT(16),
151 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ			= BIT(17),
152 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ			= BIT(18),
153 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ		= BIT(19),
154 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT			= BIT(20),
155 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT		= BIT(21),
156 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT	= BIT(22),
157 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT	= BIT(23),
158 	IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR		= BIT(24),
159 	IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP	= BIT(25),
160 	IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY     = BIT(26),
161 };
162 
163 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
164 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
165 
166 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
167 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
168 
169 /**
170  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
171  *
172  * This structure describes a single channel for use
173  * with cfg80211.
174  *
175  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
176  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
177  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
178  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
179  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
180  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
181  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
182  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
183  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
184  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
185  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
186  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
187  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
188  * @orig_mag: internal use
189  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
190  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
191  *	on this channel.
192  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
193  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
194  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
195  */
196 struct ieee80211_channel {
197 	enum nl80211_band band;
198 	u32 center_freq;
199 	u16 freq_offset;
200 	u16 hw_value;
201 	u32 flags;
202 	int max_antenna_gain;
203 	int max_power;
204 	int max_reg_power;
205 	bool beacon_found;
206 	u32 orig_flags;
207 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
208 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
209 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
210 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
211 	s8 psd;
212 };
213 
214 /**
215  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
216  *
217  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
218  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
219  * different bands/PHY modes.
220  *
221  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
222  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
223  *	with CCK rates.
224  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
225  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
226  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
227  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
228  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
229  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
230  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
231  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
232  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
233  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
234  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
235  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
236  */
237 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
238 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(0),
239 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= BIT(1),
240 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= BIT(2),
241 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= BIT(3),
242 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= BIT(4),
243 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= BIT(5),
244 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= BIT(6),
245 };
246 
247 /**
248  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
249  *
250  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
251  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
252  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
253  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
254  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
255  */
256 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
257 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
258 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
259 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
260 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
261 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
262 };
263 
264 /**
265  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
266  *
267  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
268  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
269  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
270  */
271 enum ieee80211_privacy {
272 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
273 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
274 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
275 };
276 
277 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
278 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
279 
280 /**
281  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
282  *
283  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
284  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
285  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
286  * passed around.
287  *
288  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
289  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
290  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
291  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
292  *	short preamble is used
293  */
294 struct ieee80211_rate {
295 	u32 flags;
296 	u16 bitrate;
297 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
298 };
299 
300 /**
301  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
302  *
303  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
304  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
305  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
306  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
307  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
308  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
309  *	members of the SRG
310  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
311  *	used by members of the SRG
312  */
313 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
314 	bool enable;
315 	u8 sr_ctrl;
316 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
317 	u8 min_offset;
318 	u8 max_offset;
319 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
320 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
321 };
322 
323 /**
324  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
325  *
326  * @color: the current color.
327  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
328  * @partial: define the AID equation.
329  */
330 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
331 	u8 color;
332 	bool enabled;
333 	bool partial;
334 };
335 
336 /**
337  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
338  *
339  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
340  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
341  *
342  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
343  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
344  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
345  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
346  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
347  */
348 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
349 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
350 	bool ht_supported;
351 	u8 ampdu_factor;
352 	u8 ampdu_density;
353 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
354 };
355 
356 /**
357  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
358  *
359  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
360  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
361  *
362  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
363  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
364  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
365  */
366 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
367 	bool vht_supported;
368 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
369 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
370 };
371 
372 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
373 
374 /**
375  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
376  *
377  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
378  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
379  *
380  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
381  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
382  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
383  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
384  */
385 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
386 	bool has_he;
387 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
388 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
389 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
390 };
391 
392 /**
393  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
394  *
395  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
396  * and NSS Set field"
397  *
398  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
399  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
400  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
401  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
402  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
403  */
404 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
405 	union {
406 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
407 		struct {
408 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
409 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
410 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
411 		} __packed bw;
412 	} __packed;
413 } __packed;
414 
415 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
416 
417 /**
418  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
419  *
420  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
421  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
422  *
423  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
424  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
425  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
426  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
427  */
428 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
429 	bool has_eht;
430 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
431 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
432 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
433 };
434 
435 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
436 #ifdef __CHECKER__
437 /*
438  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
439  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
440  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
441  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
442  */
443 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
444 #else
445 # define __iftd
446 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
447 
448 /**
449  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
450  *
451  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
452  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
453  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
454  *
455  * @types_mask: interface types mask
456  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
457  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
458  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
459  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
460  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
461  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
462  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
463  */
464 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
465 	u16 types_mask;
466 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
467 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
468 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
469 	struct {
470 		const u8 *data;
471 		unsigned int len;
472 	} vendor_elems;
473 };
474 
475 /**
476  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
477  *
478  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
479  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
480  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
481  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
482  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
483  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
484  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
485  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
486  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
487  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
488  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
489  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
490  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
491  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
492  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
493  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
494  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
495  */
496 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
497 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
498 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
499 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
500 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
501 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
502 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
503 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
504 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
505 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
506 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
507 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
508 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
509 };
510 
511 /**
512  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
513  *
514  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
515  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
516  *
517  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
518  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
519  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
520  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
521  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
522  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
523  */
524 struct ieee80211_edmg {
525 	u8 channels;
526 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
527 };
528 
529 /**
530  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
531  *
532  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
533  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
534  *
535  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
536  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
537  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
538  */
539 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
540 	bool s1g;
541 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
542 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
543 };
544 
545 /**
546  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
547  *
548  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
549  * is able to operate in.
550  *
551  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
552  *	in this band.
553  * @band: the band this structure represents
554  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
555  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
556  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
557  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
558  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
559  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
560  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
561  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
562  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
563  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
564  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
565  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
566  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
567  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
568  *	iftype_data).
569  */
570 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
571 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
572 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
573 	enum nl80211_band band;
574 	int n_channels;
575 	int n_bitrates;
576 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
577 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
578 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
579 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
580 	u16 n_iftype_data;
581 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
582 };
583 
584 /**
585  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
586  * @sband: the sband to initialize
587  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
588  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
589  *
590  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
591  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
592  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
593  */
594 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)595 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
596 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
597 				 u16 n_iftd)
598 {
599 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
600 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
601 }
602 
603 /**
604  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
605  * @sband: the sband to initialize
606  * @iftd: the iftype data array
607  */
608 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
609 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
610 
611 /**
612  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
613  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
614  * @i: iterator counter
615  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
616  */
617 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
618 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
619 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
620 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
621 
622 /**
623  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
624  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
625  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
626  *
627  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
628  */
629 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)630 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
631 				u8 iftype)
632 {
633 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
634 	int i;
635 
636 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
637 		return NULL;
638 
639 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
640 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
641 
642 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
643 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
644 			return data;
645 	}
646 
647 	return NULL;
648 }
649 
650 /**
651  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
652  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
653  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
654  *
655  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
656  */
657 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)658 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
659 			    u8 iftype)
660 {
661 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
662 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
663 
664 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
665 		return &data->he_cap;
666 
667 	return NULL;
668 }
669 
670 /**
671  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
672  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
673  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
674  *
675  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
676  */
677 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)678 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
679 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
680 {
681 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
682 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
683 
684 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
685 		return 0;
686 
687 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
688 }
689 
690 /**
691  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
692  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
693  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
694  *
695  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
696  */
697 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)698 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
699 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
700 {
701 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
702 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
703 
704 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
705 		return &data->eht_cap;
706 
707 	return NULL;
708 }
709 
710 /**
711  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
712  *
713  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
714  *
715  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
716  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
717  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
718  *
719  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
720  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
721  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
722  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
723  * without affecting other devices.
724  *
725  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
726  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
727  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
728  */
729 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
730 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
731 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)732 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
733 {
734 }
735 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
736 
737 
738 /*
739  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
740  */
741 
742 /**
743  * DOC: Actions and configuration
744  *
745  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
746  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
747  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
748  * operations use are described separately.
749  *
750  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
751  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
752  *
753  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
754  * in a separate chapter.
755  */
756 
757 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
758 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
759 
760 /**
761  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
762  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
763  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
764  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
765  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
766  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
767  *	determine the address as needed.
768  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
769  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
770  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
771  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
772  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
773  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
774  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
775  */
776 struct vif_params {
777 	u32 flags;
778 	int use_4addr;
779 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
780 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
781 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
782 };
783 
784 /**
785  * struct key_params - key information
786  *
787  * Information about a key
788  *
789  * @key: key material
790  * @key_len: length of key material
791  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
792  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
793  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
794  *	length given by @seq_len.
795  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
796  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
797  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
798  */
799 struct key_params {
800 	const u8 *key;
801 	const u8 *seq;
802 	int key_len;
803 	int seq_len;
804 	u16 vlan_id;
805 	u32 cipher;
806 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
807 };
808 
809 /**
810  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
811  * @chan: the (control) channel
812  * @width: channel width
813  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
814  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
815  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
816  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
817  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
818  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
819  *	parameters are ignored.
820  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
821  * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
822  *	bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
823  *	from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
824  */
825 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
826 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
827 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
828 	u32 center_freq1;
829 	u32 center_freq2;
830 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
831 	u16 freq1_offset;
832 	u16 punctured;
833 };
834 
835 /*
836  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
837  */
838 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
839 	struct {
840 		u32 legacy;
841 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
842 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
843 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
844 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
845 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
846 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
847 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
848 };
849 
850 
851 /**
852  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
853  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
854  *	of the peer.
855  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
856  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
857  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
858  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
859  * @retry_long: retry count value
860  * @retry_short: retry count value
861  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
862  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
863  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
864  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
865  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
866  */
867 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
868 	bool config_override;
869 	u8 tids;
870 	u64 mask;
871 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
872 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
873 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
874 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
875 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
876 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
877 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
878 };
879 
880 /**
881  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
882  * @peer: Station's MAC address
883  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
884  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
885  */
886 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
887 	const u8 *peer;
888 	u32 n_tid_conf;
889 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
890 };
891 
892 /**
893  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
894  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
895  * @kek: FILS KEK
896  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
897  * @snonce: STA Nonce
898  * @anonce: AP Nonce
899  */
900 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
901 	const u8 *macaddr;
902 	const u8 *kek;
903 	u8 kek_len;
904 	const u8 *snonce;
905 	const u8 *anonce;
906 };
907 
908 /**
909  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
910  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
911  *	addresses.
912  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
913  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
914  */
915 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
916 	const u8 *macaddr;
917 	bool enable;
918 };
919 
920 /**
921  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
922  * @chandef: the channel definition
923  *
924  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
925  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
926  */
927 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)928 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
929 {
930 	switch (chandef->width) {
931 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
932 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
933 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
934 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
935 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
936 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
937 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
938 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
939 	default:
940 		WARN_ON(1);
941 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
942 	}
943 }
944 
945 /**
946  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
947  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
948  * @channel: the control channel
949  * @chantype: the channel type
950  *
951  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
952  */
953 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
954 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
955 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
956 
957 /**
958  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
959  * @chandef1: first channel definition
960  * @chandef2: second channel definition
961  *
962  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
963  * identical, %false otherwise.
964  */
965 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)966 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
967 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
968 {
969 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
970 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
971 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
972 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
973 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
974 		chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
975 }
976 
977 /**
978  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
979  *
980  * @chandef: the channel definition
981  *
982  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
983  */
984 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)985 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
986 {
987 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
988 }
989 
990 /**
991  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
992  * @chandef1: first channel definition
993  * @chandef2: second channel definition
994  *
995  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
996  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
997  */
998 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
999 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
1000 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
1001 
1002 /**
1003  * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
1004  * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1005  *
1006  * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1007  * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1008  */
1009 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1010 
1011 /**
1012  * cfg80211_chandef_get_width - return chandef width in MHz
1013  * @c: chandef to return bandwidth for
1014  * Return: channel width in MHz for the given chandef; note that it returns
1015  *	80 for 80+80 configurations
1016  */
cfg80211_chandef_get_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * c)1017 static inline int cfg80211_chandef_get_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *c)
1018 {
1019 	return nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(c->width);
1020 }
1021 
1022 /**
1023  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1024  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1025  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1026  */
1027 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1028 
1029 /**
1030  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1031  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1032  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1033  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1034  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1035  */
1036 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1037 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1038 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1039 
1040 /**
1041  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1042  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1043  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1044  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1045  * Returns:
1046  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1047  */
1048 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1049 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1050 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1051 
1052 /**
1053  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1054  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1055  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1056  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1057  *
1058  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1059  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1060  */
1061 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1062 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1063 
1064 /**
1065  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1066  *				   channel definition
1067  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1068  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1069  *
1070  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1071  */
1072 unsigned int
1073 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1074 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1075 
1076 /**
1077  * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1078  * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1079  * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1080  * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1081  *	according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1082  *
1083  * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1084  *	for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1085  */
1086 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1087 			     enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1088 			     u16 *punctured);
1089 
1090 /**
1091  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1092  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1093  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1094  *
1095  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1096  **/
1097 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1098 
1099 /**
1100  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1101  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1102  *
1103  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1104  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1105  *
1106  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1107  */
1108 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1109 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1110 {
1111 	switch (width) {
1112 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1113 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1114 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1115 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1116 	default:
1117 		break;
1118 	}
1119 	return 0;
1120 }
1121 
1122 /**
1123  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1124  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1125  *
1126  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1127  *
1128  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1129  */
1130 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1131 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1132 {
1133 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1134 }
1135 
1136 /**
1137  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1138  *
1139  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1140  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1141  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1142  *
1143  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1144  *
1145  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1146  */
1147 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1148 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1149 {
1150 	switch (chandef->width) {
1151 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1152 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1153 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1154 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1155 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1156 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1157 	default:
1158 		break;
1159 	}
1160 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1161 }
1162 
1163 /**
1164  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1165  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1166  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1167  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1168  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1169  *
1170  * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1171  */
1172 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1173 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1174 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1175 
1176 /**
1177  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1178  *
1179  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1180  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1181  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1182  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1183  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1184  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1185  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1186  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1187  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1188  *
1189  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1190  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1191  */
1192 enum survey_info_flags {
1193 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1194 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1195 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1196 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1197 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1198 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1199 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1200 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1201 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1202 };
1203 
1204 /**
1205  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1206  *
1207  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1208  *	record to report global statistics
1209  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1210  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1211  *	optional
1212  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1213  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1214  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1215  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1216  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1217  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1218  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1219  *
1220  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1221  *
1222  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1223  * channel duty cycle etc.
1224  */
1225 struct survey_info {
1226 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1227 	u64 time;
1228 	u64 time_busy;
1229 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1230 	u64 time_rx;
1231 	u64 time_tx;
1232 	u64 time_scan;
1233 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1234 	u32 filled;
1235 	s8 noise;
1236 };
1237 
1238 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1239 
1240 /**
1241  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1242  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1243  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1244  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1245  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1246  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1247  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1248  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1249  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1250  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1251  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1252  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1253  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1254  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1255  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1256  *	protocol frames.
1257  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1258  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1259  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1260  *	port for mac80211
1261  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1262  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1263  *	offload)
1264  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1265  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1266  *
1267  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1268  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1269  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1270  *	  such a scenario.
1271  *
1272  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1273  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1274  *
1275  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1276  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1277  *
1278  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1279  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1280  */
1281 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1282 	u32 wpa_versions;
1283 	u32 cipher_group;
1284 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1285 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1286 	int n_akm_suites;
1287 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1288 	bool control_port;
1289 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1290 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1291 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1292 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1293 	const u8 *psk;
1294 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1295 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1296 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1297 };
1298 
1299 /**
1300  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1301  *
1302  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1303  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1304  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1305  */
1306 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1307 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1308 	u8 index;
1309 	bool ema;
1310 };
1311 
1312 /**
1313  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1314  *
1315  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1316  *
1317  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1318  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1319  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1320  */
1321 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1322 	u8 cnt;
1323 	struct {
1324 		const u8 *data;
1325 		size_t len;
1326 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1327 };
1328 
1329 /**
1330  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1331  *
1332  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1333  *
1334  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1335  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1336  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1337  */
1338 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1339 	u8 cnt;
1340 	struct {
1341 		const u8 *data;
1342 		size_t len;
1343 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1344 };
1345 
1346 /**
1347  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1348  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1349  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1350  *	or %NULL if not changed
1351  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1352  *	or %NULL if not changed
1353  * @head_len: length of @head
1354  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1355  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1356  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1357  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1358  *	frames or %NULL
1359  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1360  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1361  *	Response frames or %NULL
1362  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1363  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1364  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1365  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1366  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1367  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1368  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1369  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1370  *	(measurement type 8)
1371  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1372  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1373  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1374  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1375  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1376  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1377  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1378  */
1379 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1380 	unsigned int link_id;
1381 
1382 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1383 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1384 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1385 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1386 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1387 	const u8 *lci;
1388 	const u8 *civicloc;
1389 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1390 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1391 	s8 ftm_responder;
1392 
1393 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1394 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1395 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1396 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1397 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1398 	size_t lci_len;
1399 	size_t civicloc_len;
1400 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1401 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1402 };
1403 
1404 struct mac_address {
1405 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1406 };
1407 
1408 /**
1409  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1410  *
1411  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1412  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1413  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1414  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1415  */
1416 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1417 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1418 	int n_acl_entries;
1419 
1420 	/* Keep it last */
1421 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1422 };
1423 
1424 /**
1425  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1426  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1427  *
1428  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1429  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1430  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1431  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1432  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1433  *	frame headers.
1434  */
1435 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1436 	bool update;
1437 	u32 min_interval;
1438 	u32 max_interval;
1439 	size_t tmpl_len;
1440 	const u8 *tmpl;
1441 };
1442 
1443 /**
1444  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1445  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1446  *
1447  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1448  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1449  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1450  *	scanning
1451  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1452  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1453  */
1454 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1455 	bool update;
1456 	u32 interval;
1457 	size_t tmpl_len;
1458 	const u8 *tmpl;
1459 };
1460 
1461 /**
1462  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1463  *
1464  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1465  *
1466  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1467  * @beacon: beacon data
1468  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1469  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1470  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1471  *	user space)
1472  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1473  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1474  * @crypto: crypto settings
1475  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1476  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1477  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1478  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1479  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1480  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1481  *	MAC address based access control
1482  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1483  *	networks.
1484  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1485  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1486  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1487  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1488  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1489  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1490  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1491  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1492  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1493  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1494  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1495  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1496  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1497  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1498  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1499  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1500  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1501  */
1502 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1503 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1504 
1505 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1506 
1507 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1508 	const u8 *ssid;
1509 	size_t ssid_len;
1510 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1511 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1512 	bool privacy;
1513 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1514 	int inactivity_timeout;
1515 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1516 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1517 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1518 	bool pbss;
1519 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1520 
1521 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1522 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1523 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1524 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1525 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1526 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1527 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1528 	bool twt_responder;
1529 	u32 flags;
1530 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1531 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1532 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1533 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1534 };
1535 
1536 
1537 /**
1538  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1539  *
1540  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1541  *
1542  * @beacon: beacon data
1543  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1544  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1545  */
1546 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1547 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1548 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1549 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1550 };
1551 
1552 /**
1553  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1554  *
1555  * Used for channel switch
1556  *
1557  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1558  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1559  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1560  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1561  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1562  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1563  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1564  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1565  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1566  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1567  * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1568  *	MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1569  */
1570 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1571 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1572 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1573 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1574 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1575 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1576 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1577 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1578 	bool radar_required;
1579 	bool block_tx;
1580 	u8 count;
1581 	u8 link_id;
1582 };
1583 
1584 /**
1585  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1586  *
1587  * Used for bss color change
1588  *
1589  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1590  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1591  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1592  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1593  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1594  * @color: the color used after the change
1595  * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1596  *	0 in case of non-MLO.
1597  */
1598 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1599 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1600 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1601 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1602 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1603 	u8 count;
1604 	u8 color;
1605 	u8 link_id;
1606 };
1607 
1608 /**
1609  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1610  *
1611  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1612  *
1613  * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global
1614  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1615  *	to use for verification
1616  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1617  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1618  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1619  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1620  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1621  *	nl80211_iftype.
1622  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1623  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1624  *	the verification
1625  */
1626 struct iface_combination_params {
1627 	int radio_idx;
1628 	int num_different_channels;
1629 	u8 radar_detect;
1630 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1631 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1632 };
1633 
1634 /**
1635  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1636  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1637  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1638  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1639  *
1640  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1641  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1642  */
1643 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1644 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1645 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1646 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1647 };
1648 
1649 /**
1650  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1651  *
1652  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1653  *
1654  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1655  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1656  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1657  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1658  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1659  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1660  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1661  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1662  *	per peer TPC.
1663  */
1664 struct sta_txpwr {
1665 	s16 power;
1666 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1667 };
1668 
1669 /**
1670  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1671  *
1672  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1673  *
1674  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1675  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1676  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1677  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1678  *	(or NULL for no change)
1679  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1680  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1681  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1682  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1683  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1684  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1685  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1686  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1687  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1688  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1689  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1690  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1691  */
1692 struct link_station_parameters {
1693 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1694 	int link_id;
1695 	const u8 *link_mac;
1696 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1697 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1698 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1699 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1700 	u8 opmode_notif;
1701 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1702 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1703 	u8 he_capa_len;
1704 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1705 	bool txpwr_set;
1706 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1707 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1708 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1709 };
1710 
1711 /**
1712  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1713  *
1714  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1715  *
1716  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1717  * @link_id: the link id
1718  */
1719 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1720 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1721 	u32 link_id;
1722 };
1723 
1724 /**
1725  * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1726  *
1727  * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1728  *
1729  * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1730  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1731  * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1732  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1733  */
1734 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1735 	u16 dlink[8];
1736 	u16 ulink[8];
1737 };
1738 
1739 /**
1740  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1741  *
1742  * Used to change and create a new station.
1743  *
1744  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1745  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1746  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1747  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1748  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1749  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1750  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1751  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1752  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1753  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1754  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1755  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1756  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1757  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1758  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1759  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1760  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1761  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1762  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1763  *	to unknown)
1764  * @capability: station capability
1765  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1766  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1767  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1768  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1769  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1770  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1771  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1772  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1773  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1774  */
1775 struct station_parameters {
1776 	struct net_device *vlan;
1777 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1778 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1779 	int listen_interval;
1780 	u16 aid;
1781 	u16 vlan_id;
1782 	u16 peer_aid;
1783 	u8 plink_action;
1784 	u8 plink_state;
1785 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1786 	u8 max_sp;
1787 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1788 	u16 capability;
1789 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1790 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1791 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1792 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1793 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1794 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1795 	int support_p2p_ps;
1796 	u16 airtime_weight;
1797 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1798 };
1799 
1800 /**
1801  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1802  *
1803  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1804  *
1805  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1806  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1807  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1808  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1809  * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1810  *	using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1811  *	remove all stations.
1812  */
1813 struct station_del_parameters {
1814 	const u8 *mac;
1815 	u8 subtype;
1816 	u16 reason_code;
1817 	int link_id;
1818 };
1819 
1820 /**
1821  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1822  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1823  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1824  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1825  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1826  *	the AP MLME in the device
1827  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1828  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1829  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1830  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1831  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1832  *	supported/used)
1833  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1834  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1835  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1836  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1837  */
1838 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1839 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1840 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1841 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1842 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1843 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1844 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1845 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1846 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1847 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1848 };
1849 
1850 /**
1851  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1852  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1853  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1854  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1855  *
1856  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1857  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1858  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1859  *
1860  * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1861  * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1862  * use them before calling this.
1863  */
1864 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1865 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1866 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1867 
1868 /**
1869  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1870  *
1871  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1872  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1873  *
1874  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1875  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1876  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1877  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1878  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1879  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1880  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1881  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1882  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1883  */
1884 enum rate_info_flags {
1885 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1886 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1887 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1888 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1889 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1890 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1891 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1892 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1893 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1894 };
1895 
1896 /**
1897  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1898  *
1899  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1900  *
1901  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1902  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1903  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1904  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1905  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1906  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1907  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1908  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1909  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1910  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1911  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1912  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1913  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1914  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1915  */
1916 enum rate_info_bw {
1917 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1918 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1919 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1920 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1921 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1922 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1923 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1924 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1925 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1926 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1927 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1928 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1929 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1930 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1931 };
1932 
1933 /**
1934  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1935  *
1936  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1937  *
1938  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1939  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1940  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1941  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1942  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1943  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1944  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1945  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1946  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1947  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1948  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1949  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1950  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1951  */
1952 struct rate_info {
1953 	u16 flags;
1954 	u16 legacy;
1955 	u8 mcs;
1956 	u8 nss;
1957 	u8 bw;
1958 	u8 he_gi;
1959 	u8 he_dcm;
1960 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1961 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1962 	u8 eht_gi;
1963 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1964 };
1965 
1966 /**
1967  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1968  *
1969  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1970  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1971  *
1972  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1973  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1974  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1975  */
1976 enum bss_param_flags {
1977 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= BIT(0),
1978 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(1),
1979 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= BIT(2),
1980 };
1981 
1982 /**
1983  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1984  *
1985  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1986  *
1987  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1988  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1989  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1990  */
1991 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1992 	u8 flags;
1993 	u8 dtim_period;
1994 	u16 beacon_interval;
1995 };
1996 
1997 /**
1998  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1999  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
2000  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2001  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
2002  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
2003  * @flows: number of new flows seen
2004  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
2005  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
2006  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
2007  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
2008  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
2009  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
2010  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
2011  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
2012  */
2013 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
2014 	u32 filled;
2015 	u32 backlog_bytes;
2016 	u32 backlog_packets;
2017 	u32 flows;
2018 	u32 drops;
2019 	u32 ecn_marks;
2020 	u32 overlimit;
2021 	u32 overmemory;
2022 	u32 collisions;
2023 	u32 tx_bytes;
2024 	u32 tx_packets;
2025 	u32 max_flows;
2026 };
2027 
2028 /**
2029  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2030  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2031  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2032  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2033  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2034  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2035  *	transmitted MSDUs
2036  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2037  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2038  */
2039 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2040 	u32 filled;
2041 	u64 rx_msdu;
2042 	u64 tx_msdu;
2043 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2044 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2045 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2046 };
2047 
2048 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
2049 
2050 /**
2051  * struct station_info - station information
2052  *
2053  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2054  *
2055  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2056  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2057  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2058  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2059  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2060  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2061  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2062  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2063  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2064  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2065  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2066  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2067  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2068  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2069  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2070  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2071  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2072  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2073  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2074  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2075  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2076  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2077  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2078  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2079  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2080  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2081  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2082  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2083  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2084  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2085  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2086  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2087  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2088  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2089  * @llid: mesh local link id
2090  * @plid: mesh peer link id
2091  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2092  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2093  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2094  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2095  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2096  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2097  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2098  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2099  *	towards this station.
2100  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2101  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2102  *	from this peer
2103  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2104  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2105  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2106  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2107  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2108  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2109  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2110  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2111  *	been sent.
2112  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2113  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2114  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2115  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2116  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2117  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2118  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2119  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2120  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2121  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2122  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2123  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2124  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2125  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2126  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2127  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2128  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2129  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2130  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2131  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2132  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2133  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2134  */
2135 struct station_info {
2136 	u64 filled;
2137 	u32 connected_time;
2138 	u32 inactive_time;
2139 	u64 assoc_at;
2140 	u64 rx_bytes;
2141 	u64 tx_bytes;
2142 	s8 signal;
2143 	s8 signal_avg;
2144 
2145 	u8 chains;
2146 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2147 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2148 
2149 	struct rate_info txrate;
2150 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2151 	u32 rx_packets;
2152 	u32 tx_packets;
2153 	u32 tx_retries;
2154 	u32 tx_failed;
2155 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2156 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2157 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2158 
2159 	int generation;
2160 
2161 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2162 
2163 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2164 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2165 
2166 	s64 t_offset;
2167 	u16 llid;
2168 	u16 plid;
2169 	u8 plink_state;
2170 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2171 	u8 connected_to_as;
2172 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2173 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2174 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2175 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2176 
2177 	u32 expected_throughput;
2178 
2179 	u16 airtime_weight;
2180 
2181 	s8 ack_signal;
2182 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2183 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2184 
2185 	u64 tx_duration;
2186 	u64 rx_duration;
2187 	u64 rx_beacon;
2188 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2189 
2190 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2191 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2192 
2193 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2194 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2195 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2196 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2197 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2198 };
2199 
2200 /**
2201  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2202  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2203  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2204  */
2205 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2206 	s32 power;
2207 	u32 freq_range_index;
2208 };
2209 
2210 /**
2211  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2212  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2213  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2214  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2215  */
2216 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2217 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2218 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2219 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs);
2220 };
2221 
2222 
2223 /**
2224  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2225  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2226  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2227  */
2228 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2229 	u32 start_freq;
2230 	u32 end_freq;
2231 };
2232 
2233 /**
2234  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2235  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2236  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2237  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2238  *
2239  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2240  * range to small ones and then append them.
2241  */
2242 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2243 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2244 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2245 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2246 };
2247 
2248 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2249 /**
2250  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2251  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2252  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2253  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2254  *
2255  * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2256  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2257  * considered undefined.
2258  */
2259 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2260 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2261 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2262 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2263 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2264 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2265 {
2266 	return -ENOENT;
2267 }
2268 #endif
2269 
2270 /**
2271  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2272  *
2273  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2274  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2275  *
2276  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2277  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2278  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2279  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2280  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2281  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: deprecated, will unconditionally be refused
2282  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2283  * @MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass locally transmitted frames
2284  */
2285 enum monitor_flags {
2286 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID),
2287 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL),
2288 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL),
2289 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL),
2290 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS),
2291 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES),
2292 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE),
2293 	MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX),
2294 };
2295 
2296 /**
2297  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2298  *
2299  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2300  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2301  *
2302  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2303  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2304  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2305  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2306  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2307  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2308  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2309  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2310  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2311  */
2312 enum mpath_info_flags {
2313 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2314 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2315 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2316 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2317 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2318 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2319 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2320 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2321 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2322 };
2323 
2324 /**
2325  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2326  *
2327  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2328  *
2329  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2330  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2331  * @sn: target sequence number
2332  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2333  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2334  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2335  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2336  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2337  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2338  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2339  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2340  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2341  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2342  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2343  */
2344 struct mpath_info {
2345 	u32 filled;
2346 	u32 frame_qlen;
2347 	u32 sn;
2348 	u32 metric;
2349 	u32 exptime;
2350 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2351 	u8 discovery_retries;
2352 	u8 flags;
2353 	u8 hop_count;
2354 	u32 path_change_count;
2355 
2356 	int generation;
2357 };
2358 
2359 /**
2360  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2361  *
2362  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2363  *
2364  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2365  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2366  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2367  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2368  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2369  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2370  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2371  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2372  *	(or NULL for no change)
2373  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2374  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2375  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2376  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2377  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2378  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2379  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2380  */
2381 struct bss_parameters {
2382 	int link_id;
2383 	int use_cts_prot;
2384 	int use_short_preamble;
2385 	int use_short_slot_time;
2386 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2387 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2388 	int ap_isolate;
2389 	int ht_opmode;
2390 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2391 };
2392 
2393 /**
2394  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2395  *
2396  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2397  *
2398  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2399  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2400  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2401  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2402  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2403  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2404  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2405  *	mesh interface
2406  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2407  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2408  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2409  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2410  *	elements
2411  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2412  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2413  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2414  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2415  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2416  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2417  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2418  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2419  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2420  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2421  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2422  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2423  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2424  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2425  *	element
2426  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2427  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2428  *	element
2429  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2430  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2431  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2432  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2433  *	announcements are transmitted
2434  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2435  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2436  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2437  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2438  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2439  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2440  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2441  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2442  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2443  *	station to establish a peer link
2444  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2445  *
2446  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2447  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2448  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2449  *
2450  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2451  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2452  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2453  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2454  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2455  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2456  *	setting for new peer links.
2457  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2458  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2459  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2460  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2461  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2462  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2463  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2464  *	in the mesh formation field.
2465  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2466  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2467  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2468  *      in the mesh path table
2469  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2470  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2471  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2472  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2473  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2474  */
2475 struct mesh_config {
2476 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2477 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2478 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2479 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2480 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2481 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2482 	u8 element_ttl;
2483 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2484 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2485 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2486 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2487 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2488 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2489 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2490 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2491 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2492 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2493 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2494 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2495 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2496 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2497 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2498 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2499 	u16 ht_opmode;
2500 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2501 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2502 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2503 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2504 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2505 	u32 plink_timeout;
2506 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2507 };
2508 
2509 /**
2510  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2511  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2512  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2513  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2514  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2515  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2516  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2517  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2518  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2519  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2520  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2521  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2522  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2523  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2524  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2525  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2526  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2527  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2528  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2529  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2530  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2531  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2532  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2533  *
2534  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2535  */
2536 struct mesh_setup {
2537 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2538 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2539 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2540 	u8 sync_method;
2541 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2542 	u8 path_metric;
2543 	u8 auth_id;
2544 	const u8 *ie;
2545 	u8 ie_len;
2546 	bool is_authenticated;
2547 	bool is_secure;
2548 	bool user_mpm;
2549 	u8 dtim_period;
2550 	u16 beacon_interval;
2551 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2552 	u32 basic_rates;
2553 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2554 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2555 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2556 };
2557 
2558 /**
2559  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2560  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2561  *
2562  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2563  */
2564 struct ocb_setup {
2565 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2566 };
2567 
2568 /**
2569  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2570  * @ac: AC identifier
2571  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2572  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2573  *	1..32767]
2574  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2575  *	1..32767]
2576  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2577  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2578  */
2579 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2580 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2581 	u16 txop;
2582 	u16 cwmin;
2583 	u16 cwmax;
2584 	u8 aifs;
2585 	int link_id;
2586 };
2587 
2588 /**
2589  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2590  *
2591  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2592  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2593  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2594  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2595  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2596  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2597  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2598  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2599  * in the wiphy structure.
2600  *
2601  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2602  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2603  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2604  *
2605  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2606  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2607  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2608  * to userspace.
2609  */
2610 
2611 /**
2612  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2613  * @ssid: the SSID
2614  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2615  */
2616 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2617 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2618 	u8 ssid_len;
2619 };
2620 
2621 /**
2622  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2623  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2624  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2625  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2626  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2627  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2628  *	userspace will be notified of that
2629  */
2630 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2631 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2632 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2633 	bool aborted;
2634 };
2635 
2636 /**
2637  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2638  *
2639  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2640  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2641  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2642  *	 which the above info is relevant to
2643  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2644  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2645  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2646  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2647  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2648  */
2649 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2650 	u32 short_ssid;
2651 	u32 channel_idx;
2652 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2653 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2654 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2655 	bool psc_no_listen;
2656 	s8 psd_20;
2657 };
2658 
2659 /**
2660  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2661  *
2662  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2663  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2664  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2665  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2666  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2667  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2668  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2669  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2670  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2671  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2672  *	%duration field.
2673  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2674  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2675  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2676  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2677  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2678  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2679  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2680  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2681  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2682  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2683  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2684  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2685  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2686  *	true if this is the second scan request
2687  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2688  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2689  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2690  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2691  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2692  */
2693 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2694 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2695 	int n_ssids;
2696 	u32 n_channels;
2697 	const u8 *ie;
2698 	size_t ie_len;
2699 	u16 duration;
2700 	bool duration_mandatory;
2701 	u32 flags;
2702 
2703 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2704 
2705 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2706 
2707 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2708 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2709 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2710 
2711 	/* internal */
2712 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2713 	unsigned long scan_start;
2714 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2715 	bool notified;
2716 	bool no_cck;
2717 	bool scan_6ghz;
2718 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2719 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2720 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2721 
2722 	/* keep last */
2723 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2724 };
2725 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2726 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2727 {
2728 	int i;
2729 
2730 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2731 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2732 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2733 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2734 	}
2735 }
2736 
2737 /**
2738  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2739  *
2740  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2741  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2742  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2743  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2744  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2745  */
2746 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2747 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2748 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2749 	s32 rssi_thold;
2750 };
2751 
2752 /**
2753  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2754  *
2755  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2756  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2757  *	infinite loop.
2758  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2759  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2760  */
2761 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2762 	u32 interval;
2763 	u32 iterations;
2764 };
2765 
2766 /**
2767  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2768  *
2769  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2770  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2771  */
2772 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2773 	enum nl80211_band band;
2774 	s8 delta;
2775 };
2776 
2777 /**
2778  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2779  *
2780  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2781  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2782  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2783  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2784  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2785  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2786  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2787  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2788  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2789  *	(others are filtered out).
2790  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2791  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2792  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2793  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2794  * @dev: the interface
2795  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2796  * @channels: channels to scan
2797  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2798  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2799  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2800  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2801  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2802  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2803  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2804  *	index must be executed first.
2805  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2806  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2807  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2808  *	owned by a particular socket)
2809  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2810  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2811  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2812  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2813  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2814  *	supported.
2815  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2816  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2817  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2818  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2819  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2820  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2821  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2822  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2823  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2824  *	comparisons.
2825  */
2826 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2827 	u64 reqid;
2828 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2829 	int n_ssids;
2830 	u32 n_channels;
2831 	const u8 *ie;
2832 	size_t ie_len;
2833 	u32 flags;
2834 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2835 	int n_match_sets;
2836 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2837 	u32 delay;
2838 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2839 	int n_scan_plans;
2840 
2841 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2842 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2843 
2844 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2845 	s8 relative_rssi;
2846 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2847 
2848 	/* internal */
2849 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2850 	struct net_device *dev;
2851 	unsigned long scan_start;
2852 	bool report_results;
2853 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2854 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2855 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2856 	struct list_head list;
2857 
2858 	/* keep last */
2859 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2860 };
2861 
2862 /**
2863  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2864  *
2865  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2866  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2867  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2868  */
2869 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2870 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2871 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2872 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2873 };
2874 
2875 /**
2876  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2877  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2878  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2879  *	signal type
2880  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2881  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2882  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2883  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2884  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2885  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2886  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2887  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2888  *	by %parent_bssid.
2889  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2890  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2891  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2892  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2893  * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2894  *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2895  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2896  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2897  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2898  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2899  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2900  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2901  */
2902 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2903 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2904 	s32 signal;
2905 	u64 boottime_ns;
2906 	u64 parent_tsf;
2907 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2908 	u8 chains;
2909 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2910 
2911 	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2912 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2913 
2914 	void *drv_data;
2915 };
2916 
2917 /**
2918  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2919  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2920  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2921  * @len: length of the IEs
2922  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2923  * @data: IE data
2924  */
2925 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2926 	u64 tsf;
2927 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2928 	int len;
2929 	bool from_beacon;
2930 	u8 data[];
2931 };
2932 
2933 /**
2934  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2935  *
2936  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2937  * for use in scan results and similar.
2938  *
2939  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2940  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2941  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2942  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2943  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2944  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2945  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2946  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2947  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2948  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2949  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2950  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2951  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2952  * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2953  *	cannot rely on it having valid data
2954  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2955  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2956  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2957  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2958  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2959  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2960  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2961  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2962  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2963  * @ts_boottime: timestamp of the last BSS update in nanoseconds since boot
2964  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2965  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2966  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2967  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2968  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2969  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2970  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2971  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2972  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2973  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2974  */
2975 struct cfg80211_bss {
2976 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2977 
2978 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2979 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2980 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2981 
2982 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2983 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2984 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2985 
2986 	s32 signal;
2987 
2988 	u64 ts_boottime;
2989 
2990 	u16 beacon_interval;
2991 	u16 capability;
2992 
2993 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2994 	u8 chains;
2995 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2996 
2997 	u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2998 
2999 	u8 bssid_index;
3000 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
3001 
3002 	u8 use_for;
3003 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
3004 
3005 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
3006 };
3007 
3008 /**
3009  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
3010  * @bss: the bss to search
3011  * @id: the element ID
3012  *
3013  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3014  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3015  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3016  */
3017 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
3018 
3019 /**
3020  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3021  * @bss: the bss to search
3022  * @id: the element ID
3023  *
3024  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3025  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3026  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3027  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3028 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3029 {
3030 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3031 }
3032 
3033 
3034 /**
3035  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3036  *
3037  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3038  * authentication.
3039  *
3040  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3041  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
3042  * @supported_selectors: List of selectors that should be assumed to be
3043  *	supported by the station.
3044  *	SAE_H2E must be assumed supported if set to %NULL.
3045  * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3046  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3047  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3048  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3049  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3050  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3051  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3052  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3053  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3054  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3055  *	transaction sequence number field.
3056  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3057  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3058  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3059  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3060  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3061  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3062  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3063  */
3064 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3065 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3066 	const u8 *ie;
3067 	size_t ie_len;
3068 	const u8 *supported_selectors;
3069 	u8 supported_selectors_len;
3070 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3071 	const u8 *key;
3072 	u8 key_len;
3073 	s8 key_idx;
3074 	const u8 *auth_data;
3075 	size_t auth_data_len;
3076 	s8 link_id;
3077 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3078 };
3079 
3080 /**
3081  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3082  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3083  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3084  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3085  * @elems_len: length of the elements
3086  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3087  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3088  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3089  *	operation as a whole must fail.
3090  */
3091 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3092 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3093 	const u8 *elems;
3094 	size_t elems_len;
3095 	bool disabled;
3096 	int error;
3097 };
3098 
3099 /**
3100  * struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req - MLO link reconfiguration request
3101  * @add_links: data for links to add, see &struct cfg80211_assoc_link
3102  * @rem_links: bitmap of links to remove
3103  * @ext_mld_capa_ops: extended MLD capabilities and operations set by
3104  *	userspace for the ML reconfiguration action frame
3105  */
3106 struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req {
3107 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link add_links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3108 	u16 rem_links;
3109 	u16 ext_mld_capa_ops;
3110 };
3111 
3112 /**
3113  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3114  *
3115  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3116  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3117  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3118  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3119  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3120  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3121  *	request (connect callback).
3122  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3123  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3124  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3125  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3126  *	flag is not set.
3127  * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3128  */
3129 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3130 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3131 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3132 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3133 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3134 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3135 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3136 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3137 	ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU			= BIT(7),
3138 };
3139 
3140 /**
3141  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3142  *
3143  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3144  * (re)association.
3145  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3146  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3147  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3148  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3149  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3150  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3151  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3152  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3153  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3154  * @crypto: crypto settings
3155  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3156  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3157  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3158  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3159  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3160  *	frame.
3161  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3162  * @supported_selectors: supported BSS selectors in IEEE 802.11 format
3163  *	(or %NULL for no change).
3164  *	If %NULL, then support for SAE_H2E should be assumed.
3165  * @supported_selectors_len: number of supported BSS selectors
3166  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3167  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3168  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3169  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3170  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3171  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3172  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3173  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3174  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3175  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3176  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3177  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3178  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3179  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3180  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3181  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3182  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3183  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3184  * @ext_mld_capa_ops: extended MLD capabilities and operations set by
3185  *	userspace for the association
3186  */
3187 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3188 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3189 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3190 	size_t ie_len;
3191 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3192 	bool use_mfp;
3193 	u32 flags;
3194 	const u8 *supported_selectors;
3195 	u8 supported_selectors_len;
3196 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3197 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3198 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3199 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3200 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3201 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3202 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3203 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3204 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3205 	s8 link_id;
3206 	u16 ext_mld_capa_ops;
3207 };
3208 
3209 /**
3210  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3211  *
3212  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3213  * deauthentication.
3214  *
3215  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3216  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3217  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3218  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3219  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3220  *	do not set a deauth frame
3221  */
3222 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3223 	const u8 *bssid;
3224 	const u8 *ie;
3225 	size_t ie_len;
3226 	u16 reason_code;
3227 	bool local_state_change;
3228 };
3229 
3230 /**
3231  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3232  *
3233  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3234  * disassociation.
3235  *
3236  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3237  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3238  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3239  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3240  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3241  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3242  */
3243 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3244 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3245 	const u8 *ie;
3246 	size_t ie_len;
3247 	u16 reason_code;
3248 	bool local_state_change;
3249 };
3250 
3251 /**
3252  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3253  *
3254  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3255  * method.
3256  *
3257  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3258  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3259  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3260  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3261  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3262  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3263  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3264  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3265  * @ie_len: length of that
3266  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3267  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3268  *	after joining
3269  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3270  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3271  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3272  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3273  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3274  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3275  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3276  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3277  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3278  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3279  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3280  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3281  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3282  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3283  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3284  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3285  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3286  */
3287 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3288 	const u8 *ssid;
3289 	const u8 *bssid;
3290 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3291 	const u8 *ie;
3292 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3293 	u16 beacon_interval;
3294 	u32 basic_rates;
3295 	bool channel_fixed;
3296 	bool privacy;
3297 	bool control_port;
3298 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3299 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3300 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3301 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3302 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3303 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3304 	int wep_tx_key;
3305 };
3306 
3307 /**
3308  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3309  *
3310  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3311  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3312  * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3313  * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3314  */
3315 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3316 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3317 	union {
3318 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3319 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3320 	} param;
3321 };
3322 
3323 /**
3324  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3325  *
3326  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3327  * authentication and association.
3328  *
3329  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3330  *	on scan results)
3331  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3332  *	%NULL if not specified
3333  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3334  *	results)
3335  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3336  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3337  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3338  *	to use.
3339  * @ssid: SSID
3340  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3341  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3342  * @ie: IEs for association request
3343  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3344  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3345  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3346  * @crypto: crypto settings
3347  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3348  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3349  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3350  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3351  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3352  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3353  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3354  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3355  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3356  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3357  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3358  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3359  *	networks.
3360  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3361  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3362  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3363  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3364  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3365  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3366  *	frame.
3367  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3368  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3369  *	data IE.
3370  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3371  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3372  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3373  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3374  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3375  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3376  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3377  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3378  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3379  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3380  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3381  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3382  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3383  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3384  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3385  */
3386 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3387 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3388 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3389 	const u8 *bssid;
3390 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3391 	const u8 *ssid;
3392 	size_t ssid_len;
3393 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3394 	const u8 *ie;
3395 	size_t ie_len;
3396 	bool privacy;
3397 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3398 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3399 	const u8 *key;
3400 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3401 	u32 flags;
3402 	int bg_scan_period;
3403 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3404 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3405 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3406 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3407 	bool pbss;
3408 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3409 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3410 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3411 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3412 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3413 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3414 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3415 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3416 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3417 	bool want_1x;
3418 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3419 };
3420 
3421 /**
3422  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3423  *
3424  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3425  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3426  *
3427  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3428  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3429  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3430  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3431  */
3432 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3433 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3434 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3435 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3436 };
3437 
3438 /**
3439  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3440  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3441  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3442  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3443  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3444  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3445  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3446  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3447  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3448  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3449  */
3450 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3451 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= BIT(0),
3452 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= BIT(1),
3453 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= BIT(2),
3454 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= BIT(3),
3455 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= BIT(4),
3456 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= BIT(5),
3457 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= BIT(6),
3458 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= BIT(7),
3459 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= BIT(8),
3460 };
3461 
3462 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3463 
3464 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3465 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3466 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3467 
3468 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3469 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3470 
3471 /**
3472  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3473  *
3474  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3475  * caching.
3476  *
3477  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3478  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3479  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3480  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3481  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3482  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3483  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3484  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3485  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3486  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3487  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3488  *	%NULL).
3489  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3490  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3491  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3492  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3493  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3494  *	used for it expires.
3495  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3496  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3497  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3498  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3499  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3500  */
3501 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3502 	const u8 *bssid;
3503 	const u8 *pmkid;
3504 	const u8 *pmk;
3505 	size_t pmk_len;
3506 	const u8 *ssid;
3507 	size_t ssid_len;
3508 	const u8 *cache_id;
3509 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3510 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3511 };
3512 
3513 /**
3514  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3515  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3516  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3517  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3518  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3519  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3520  *
3521  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3522  * memory, free @mask only!
3523  */
3524 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3525 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3526 	int pattern_len;
3527 	int pkt_offset;
3528 };
3529 
3530 /**
3531  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3532  *
3533  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3534  * @src: source IP address
3535  * @dst: destination IP address
3536  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3537  * @src_port: source port
3538  * @dst_port: destination port
3539  * @payload_len: data payload length
3540  * @payload: data payload buffer
3541  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3542  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3543  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3544  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3545  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3546  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3547  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3548  */
3549 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3550 	struct socket *sock;
3551 	__be32 src, dst;
3552 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3553 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3554 	int payload_len;
3555 	const u8 *payload;
3556 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3557 	u32 data_interval;
3558 	u32 wake_len;
3559 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3560 	u32 tokens_size;
3561 	/* must be last, variable member */
3562 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3563 };
3564 
3565 /**
3566  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3567  *
3568  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3569  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3570  *	operating as normal during suspend
3571  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3572  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3573  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3574  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3575  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3576  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3577  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3578  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3579  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3580  *	NULL if not configured.
3581  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3582  */
3583 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3584 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3585 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3586 	     rfkill_release;
3587 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3588 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3589 	int n_patterns;
3590 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3591 };
3592 
3593 /**
3594  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3595  *
3596  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3597  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3598  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3599  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3600  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3601  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3602  */
3603 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3604 	int delay;
3605 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3606 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3607 	int n_patterns;
3608 };
3609 
3610 /**
3611  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3612  *
3613  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3614  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3615  * @n_rules: number of rules
3616  */
3617 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3618 	int n_rules;
3619 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules);
3620 };
3621 
3622 /**
3623  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3624  *
3625  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3626  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3627  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3628  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3629  *	occurred (in MHz)
3630  */
3631 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3632 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3633 	int n_channels;
3634 	u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
3635 };
3636 
3637 /**
3638  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3639  *
3640  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3641  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3642  *	match information.
3643  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3644  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3645  */
3646 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3647 	int n_matches;
3648 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches);
3649 };
3650 
3651 /**
3652  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3653  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3654  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3655  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3656  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3657  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3658  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3659  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3660  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3661  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3662  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3663  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3664  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3665  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3666  *	it is.
3667  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3668  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3669  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3670  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3671  * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3672  *	disassoc frame (in MFP).
3673  */
3674 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3675 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3676 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3677 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3678 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3679 	     unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3680 	s32 pattern_idx;
3681 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3682 	const void *packet;
3683 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3684 };
3685 
3686 /**
3687  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3688  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3689  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3690  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3691  * @kek_len: length of kek
3692  * @kck_len: length of kck
3693  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3694  */
3695 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3696 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3697 	u32 akm;
3698 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3699 };
3700 
3701 /**
3702  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3703  *
3704  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3705  *
3706  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3707  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3708  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3709  */
3710 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3711 	u16 md;
3712 	const u8 *ie;
3713 	size_t ie_len;
3714 };
3715 
3716 /**
3717  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3718  *
3719  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3720  *
3721  * @chan: channel to use
3722  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3723  * @wait: duration for ROC
3724  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3725  * @len: buffer length
3726  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3727  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3728  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3729  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3730  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3731  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3732  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3733  */
3734 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3735 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3736 	bool offchan;
3737 	unsigned int wait;
3738 	const u8 *buf;
3739 	size_t len;
3740 	bool no_cck;
3741 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3742 	int n_csa_offsets;
3743 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3744 	int link_id;
3745 };
3746 
3747 /**
3748  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3749  *
3750  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3751  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3752  */
3753 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3754 	u8 dscp;
3755 	u8 up;
3756 };
3757 
3758 /**
3759  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3760  *
3761  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3762  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3763  */
3764 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3765 	u8 low;
3766 	u8 high;
3767 };
3768 
3769 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3770 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3771 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3772 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3773 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3774 
3775 /**
3776  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3777  *
3778  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3779  *
3780  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3781  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3782  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3783  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3784  */
3785 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3786 	u8 num_des;
3787 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3788 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3789 };
3790 
3791 /**
3792  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3793  *
3794  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3795  *
3796  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3797  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3798  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3799  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3800  */
3801 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3802 	u8 master_pref;
3803 	u8 bands;
3804 };
3805 
3806 /**
3807  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3808  * configuration
3809  *
3810  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3811  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3812  */
3813 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3814 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3815 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3816 };
3817 
3818 /**
3819  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3820  *
3821  * @filter: the content of the filter
3822  * @len: the length of the filter
3823  */
3824 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3825 	const u8 *filter;
3826 	u8 len;
3827 };
3828 
3829 /**
3830  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3831  *
3832  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3833  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3834  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3835  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3836  *	implementation specific.
3837  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3838  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3839  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3840  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3841  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3842  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3843  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3844  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3845  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3846  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3847  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3848  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3849  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3850  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3851  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3852  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3853  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3854  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3855  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3856  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3857  */
3858 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3859 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3860 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3861 	u8 publish_type;
3862 	bool close_range;
3863 	bool publish_bcast;
3864 	bool subscribe_active;
3865 	u8 followup_id;
3866 	u8 followup_reqid;
3867 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3868 	u32 ttl;
3869 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3870 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3871 	bool srf_include;
3872 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3873 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3874 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3875 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3876 	int srf_num_macs;
3877 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3878 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3879 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3880 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3881 	u8 instance_id;
3882 	u64 cookie;
3883 };
3884 
3885 /**
3886  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3887  *
3888  * @aa: authenticator address
3889  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3890  * @pmk: the PMK material
3891  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3892  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3893  *	holds PMK-R0.
3894  */
3895 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3896 	const u8 *aa;
3897 	u8 pmk_len;
3898 	const u8 *pmk;
3899 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3900 };
3901 
3902 /**
3903  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3904  *
3905  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3906  *
3907  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3908  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3909  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3910  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3911  *	authentication response command interface.
3912  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3913  *	authentication response command interface.
3914  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3915  *	authentication request event interface.
3916  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3917  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3918  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3919  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3920  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3921  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3922  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3923  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3924  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3925  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3926  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3927  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3928  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3929  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3930  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3931  *	chosen for the authentication.
3932  */
3933 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3934 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3935 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3936 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3937 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3938 	u16 status;
3939 	const u8 *pmkid;
3940 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3941 };
3942 
3943 /**
3944  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3945  *
3946  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3947  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3948  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3949  *	answered
3950  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3951  *	successfully answered
3952  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3953  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3954  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3955  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3956  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3957  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3958  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3959  *	the responder
3960  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3961  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3962  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3963  */
3964 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3965 	u32 filled;
3966 	u32 success_num;
3967 	u32 partial_num;
3968 	u32 failed_num;
3969 	u32 asap_num;
3970 	u32 non_asap_num;
3971 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3972 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3973 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3974 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3975 };
3976 
3977 /**
3978  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3979  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3980  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3981  *	reason than just "failure"
3982  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3983  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3984  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3985  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3986  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3987  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3988  *	by the responder
3989  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3990  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3991  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3992  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3993  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3994  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3995  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3996  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3997  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3998  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3999  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
4000  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
4001  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
4002  *	the square root of the variance)
4003  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
4004  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
4005  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
4006  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
4007  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
4008  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
4009  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
4010  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
4011  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
4012  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
4013  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
4014  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
4015  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
4016  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
4017  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
4018  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
4019  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
4020  */
4021 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
4022 	const u8 *lci;
4023 	const u8 *civicloc;
4024 	unsigned int lci_len;
4025 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
4026 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
4027 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
4028 	s16 burst_index;
4029 	u8 busy_retry_time;
4030 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4031 	u8 burst_duration;
4032 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4033 	s32 rssi_avg;
4034 	s32 rssi_spread;
4035 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
4036 	s64 rtt_avg;
4037 	s64 rtt_variance;
4038 	s64 rtt_spread;
4039 	s64 dist_avg;
4040 	s64 dist_variance;
4041 	s64 dist_spread;
4042 
4043 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
4044 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
4045 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
4046 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
4047 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
4048 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
4049 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
4050 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
4051 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
4052 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
4053 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
4054 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
4055 };
4056 
4057 /**
4058  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4059  * @addr: address of the peer
4060  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4061  *	measurement was made)
4062  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4063  * @status: status of the measurement
4064  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4065  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
4066  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4067  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4068  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4069  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
4070  * @ftm: FTM result
4071  */
4072 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4073 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4074 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4075 
4076 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4077 
4078 	u8 final:1,
4079 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
4080 
4081 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4082 
4083 	union {
4084 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4085 	};
4086 };
4087 
4088 /**
4089  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4090  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4091  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4092  * @burst_period: burst period to use
4093  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4094  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4095  * @burst_duration: burst duration
4096  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4097  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4098  * @request_lci: request LCI information
4099  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4100  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4101  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4102  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4103  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4104  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4105  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4106  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4107  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4108  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4109  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4110  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4111  *
4112  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4113  */
4114 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4115 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4116 	u16 burst_period;
4117 	u8 requested:1,
4118 	   asap:1,
4119 	   request_lci:1,
4120 	   request_civicloc:1,
4121 	   trigger_based:1,
4122 	   non_trigger_based:1,
4123 	   lmr_feedback:1;
4124 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4125 	u8 burst_duration;
4126 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4127 	u8 ftmr_retries;
4128 	u8 bss_color;
4129 };
4130 
4131 /**
4132  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4133  * @addr: MAC address
4134  * @chandef: channel to use
4135  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4136  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4137  */
4138 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4139 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4140 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4141 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4142 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4143 };
4144 
4145 /**
4146  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4147  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4148  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4149  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4150  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4151  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4152  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4153  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4154  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4155  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4156  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4157  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4158  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4159  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4160  */
4161 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4162 	u64 cookie;
4163 	void *drv_data;
4164 	u32 n_peers;
4165 	u32 nl_portid;
4166 
4167 	u32 timeout;
4168 
4169 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4170 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4171 
4172 	struct list_head list;
4173 
4174 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4175 };
4176 
4177 /**
4178  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4179  *
4180  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4181  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4182  *
4183  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4184  *
4185  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4186  *	has to be done.
4187  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4188  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4189  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4190  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4191  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4192  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4193  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4194  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4195  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4196  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4197  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4198  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4199  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4200  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4201  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4202  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4203  */
4204 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4205 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4206 	u16 status;
4207 	const u8 *ie;
4208 	size_t ie_len;
4209 	int assoc_link_id;
4210 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4211 };
4212 
4213 /**
4214  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4215  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4216  *	for the entire device
4217  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4218  *	for the given interface
4219  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4220  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4221  *	for these subtypes
4222  */
4223 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4224 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4225 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4226 };
4227 
4228 /**
4229  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4230  *
4231  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4232  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4233  *
4234  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4235  * on success or a negative error code.
4236  *
4237  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4238  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4239  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4240  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4241  *
4242  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4243  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4244  *	configured for the device.
4245  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4246  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4247  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4248  *	the device.
4249  *
4250  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4251  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4252  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4253  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4254  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4255  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4256  *
4257  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4258  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4259  *
4260  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4261  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4262  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4263  *
4264  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4265  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4266  *	address is available.
4267  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4268  *
4269  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4270  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4271  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4272  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4273  *
4274  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4275  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4276  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4277  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4278  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4279  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4280  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4281  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4282  *
4283  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4284  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4285  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4286  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4287  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4288  *
4289  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4290  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4291  *
4292  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4293  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4294  *
4295  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4296  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4297  *
4298  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4299  *
4300  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4301  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4302  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4303  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4304  *
4305  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4306  * @del_station: Remove a station
4307  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4308  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4309  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4310  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4311  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4312  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4313  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4314  *
4315  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4316  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4317  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4318  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4319  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4320  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4321  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4322  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4323  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4324  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4325  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4326  *
4327  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4328  *
4329  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4330  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4331  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4332  *
4333  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4334  *
4335  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4336  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4337  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4338  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4339  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4340  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4341  *
4342  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4343  *
4344  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4345  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4346  *	join the mesh instead.
4347  *
4348  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4349  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4350  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4351  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4352  *
4353  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4354  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4355  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4356  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4357  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4358  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4359  *
4360  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4361  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4362  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4363  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4364  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4365  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4366  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4367  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4368  *
4369  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4370  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4371  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4372  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4373  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4374  *	was received.
4375  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4376  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4377  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4378  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4379  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4380  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4381  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4382  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4383  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4384  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4385  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4386  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4387  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4388  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4389  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4390  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4391  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4392  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4393  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4394  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4395  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4396  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4397  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4398  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4399  *
4400  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4401  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4402  *	to a merge.
4403  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4404  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4405  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4406  *
4407  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4408  *	MESH mode)
4409  *
4410  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4411  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4412  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4413  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4414  *
4415  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4416  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4417  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4418  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4419  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4420  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4421  *	return 0 if successful
4422  *
4423  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4424  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4425  *
4426  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4427  *
4428  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4429  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4430  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4431  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4432  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4433  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4434  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4435  *	the duration value.
4436  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4437  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4438  *	frame on another channel
4439  *
4440  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4441  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4442  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4443  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4444  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4445  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4446  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4447  *
4448  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4449  *
4450  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4451  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4452  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4453  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4454  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4455  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4456  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4457  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4458  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4459  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4460  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4461  *	disabled.)
4462  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4463  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4464  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4465  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4466  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4467  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4468  *	thresholds.
4469  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4470  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4471  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4472  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4473  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4474  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4475  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4476  *
4477  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4478  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4479  *
4480  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4481  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4482  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4483  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4484  *
4485  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4486  *
4487  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4488  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4489  *
4490  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4491  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4492  *
4493  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4494  *
4495  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4496  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4497  *	current monitoring channel.
4498  *
4499  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4500  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4501  *
4502  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4503  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4504  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4505  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4506  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4507  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4508  *
4509  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4510  *
4511  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4512  *	was finished on another phy.
4513  *
4514  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4515  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4516  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4517  *
4518  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4519  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4520  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4521  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4522  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4523  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4524  *
4525  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4526  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4527  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4528  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4529  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4530  *	as soon as possible.
4531  *
4532  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4533  *
4534  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4535  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4536  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4537  *
4538  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4539  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4540  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4541  *	account.
4542  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4543  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4544  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4545  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4546  *	rejected)
4547  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4548  *
4549  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4550  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4551  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4552  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4553  *
4554  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4555  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4556  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4557  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4558  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4559  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4560  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4561  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4562  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4563  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4564  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4565  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4566  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4567  *	provided @nan_func.
4568  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4569  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4570  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4571  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4572  *
4573  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4574  *
4575  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4576  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4577  *
4578  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4579  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4580  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4581  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4582  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4583  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4584  *
4585  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4586  *     user space
4587  *
4588  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4589  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4590  *
4591  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4592  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4593  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4594  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4595  *
4596  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4597  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4598  *	DH IE through this interface.
4599  *
4600  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4601  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4602  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4603  *	This callback may sleep.
4604  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4605  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4606  *
4607  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4608  *
4609  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4610  *
4611  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4612  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4613  *	Response frame.
4614  *
4615  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4616  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4617  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4618  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4619  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4620  *	radar channel.
4621  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4622  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4623  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4624  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4625  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4626  *
4627  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4628  * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4629  * @set_epcs: Enable/Disable EPCS for station mode.
4630  * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use.
4631  *	(invoked with the wiphy mutex held)
4632  * @assoc_ml_reconf: Request a non-AP MLO connection to perform ML
4633  *	reconfiguration, i.e., add and/or remove links to/from the
4634  *	association using ML reconfiguration action frames. Successfully added
4635  *	links will be added to the set of valid links. Successfully removed
4636  *	links will be removed from the set of valid links. The driver must
4637  *	indicate removed links by calling cfg80211_links_removed() and added
4638  *	links by calling cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). When calling
4639  *	cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done() the bss pointer must be given for each
4640  *	link for which MLO reconfiguration 'add' operation was requested.
4641  */
4642 struct cfg80211_ops {
4643 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4644 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4645 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4646 
4647 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4648 						  const char *name,
4649 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4650 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4651 						  struct vif_params *params);
4652 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4653 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4654 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4655 				       struct net_device *dev,
4656 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4657 				       struct vif_params *params);
4658 
4659 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4660 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4661 				 unsigned int link_id);
4662 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4663 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4664 				 unsigned int link_id);
4665 
4666 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4667 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4668 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4669 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4670 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4671 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4672 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4673 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4674 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4675 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4676 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4677 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4678 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4679 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4680 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4681 					u8 key_index);
4682 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4683 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4684 					  int link_id,
4685 					  u8 key_index);
4686 
4687 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4688 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4689 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4690 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4691 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4692 			   unsigned int link_id);
4693 
4694 
4695 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4696 			       const u8 *mac,
4697 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4698 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4699 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4700 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4701 				  const u8 *mac,
4702 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4703 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4704 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4705 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4706 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4707 
4708 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4709 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4710 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4711 			       const u8 *dst);
4712 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4713 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4714 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4715 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4716 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4717 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4718 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4719 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4720 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4721 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4722 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4723 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4724 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4725 				struct net_device *dev,
4726 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4727 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4728 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4729 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4730 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4731 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4732 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4733 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4734 
4735 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4736 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4737 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4738 
4739 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4740 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4741 
4742 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4743 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4744 
4745 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4746 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4747 
4748 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4749 					     struct net_device *dev,
4750 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4751 
4752 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4753 				       struct net_device *dev,
4754 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4755 
4756 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4757 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4758 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4759 
4760 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4761 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4762 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4763 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4764 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4765 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4766 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4767 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4768 
4769 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4770 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4771 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4772 					 struct net_device *dev,
4773 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4774 					 u32 changed);
4775 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4776 			      u16 reason_code);
4777 
4778 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4779 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4780 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4781 
4782 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4783 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4784 
4785 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4786 
4787 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4788 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4789 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4790 				unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4791 
4792 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4793 
4794 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4795 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4796 				void *data, int len);
4797 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4798 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4799 				 void *data, int len);
4800 #endif
4801 
4802 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4803 				    struct net_device *dev,
4804 				    unsigned int link_id,
4805 				    const u8 *peer,
4806 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4807 
4808 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4809 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4810 
4811 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4812 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4813 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4814 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4815 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4816 
4817 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4818 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4819 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4820 				     unsigned int duration,
4821 				     u64 *cookie);
4822 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4823 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4824 					    u64 cookie);
4825 
4826 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4827 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4828 			   u64 *cookie);
4829 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4830 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4831 				       u64 cookie);
4832 
4833 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4834 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4835 
4836 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4837 				       struct net_device *dev,
4838 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4839 
4840 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4841 					     struct net_device *dev,
4842 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4843 
4844 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4845 				      struct net_device *dev,
4846 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4847 
4848 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4849 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4850 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4851 
4852 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4853 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4854 
4855 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4856 				struct net_device *dev,
4857 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4858 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4859 				   u64 reqid);
4860 
4861 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4862 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4863 
4864 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4865 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4866 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4867 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4868 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4869 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4870 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4871 
4872 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4873 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4874 
4875 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4876 				  struct net_device *dev,
4877 				  u16 noack_map);
4878 
4879 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4880 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4881 			       unsigned int link_id,
4882 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4883 
4884 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4885 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4886 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4887 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4888 
4889 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4890 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4891 
4892 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4893 					 struct net_device *dev,
4894 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4895 					 u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id);
4896 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4897 			   struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id);
4898 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4899 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4900 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4901 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4902 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4903 				    u16 duration);
4904 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4905 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4906 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4907 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4908 
4909 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4910 				  struct net_device *dev,
4911 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4912 
4913 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4914 			       struct net_device *dev,
4915 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4916 
4917 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4918 				    unsigned int link_id,
4919 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4920 
4921 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4922 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4923 			     u16 admitted_time);
4924 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4925 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4926 
4927 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4928 				       struct net_device *dev,
4929 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4930 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4931 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4932 					      struct net_device *dev,
4933 					      const u8 *addr);
4934 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4935 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4936 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4937 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4938 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4939 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4940 			       u64 cookie);
4941 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4942 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4943 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4944 				   u32 changes);
4945 
4946 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4947 					    struct net_device *dev,
4948 					    const bool enabled);
4949 
4950 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4951 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4952 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4953 
4954 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4955 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4956 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4957 			   const u8 *aa);
4958 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4959 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4960 
4961 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4962 				   struct net_device *dev,
4963 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4964 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4965 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4966 				   u64 *cookie);
4967 
4968 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4969 				struct net_device *dev,
4970 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4971 
4972 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4973 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4974 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4975 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4976 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4977 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4978 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4979 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4980 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4981 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4982 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4983 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4984 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4985 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4986 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4987 				struct net_device *dev,
4988 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4989 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4990 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4991 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4992 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4993 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4994 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4995 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4996 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4997 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4998 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4999 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5000 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
5001 	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5002 			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
5003 	u32	(*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
5004 	int     (*assoc_ml_reconf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5005 				   struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req *req);
5006 	int	(*set_epcs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5007 			    bool val);
5008 };
5009 
5010 /*
5011  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
5012  * and registration/helper functions
5013  */
5014 
5015 /**
5016  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
5017  *
5018  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
5019  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
5020  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
5021  *	wiphy at all
5022  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
5023  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
5024  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
5025  *	reason to override the default
5026  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
5027  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
5028  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
5029  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
5030  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
5031  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
5032  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
5033  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
5034  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
5035  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
5036  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
5037  *	firmware.
5038  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
5039  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
5040  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
5041  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
5042  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
5043  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
5044  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
5045  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
5046  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
5047  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
5048  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
5049  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
5050  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
5051  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
5052  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
5053  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
5054  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
5055  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
5056  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
5057  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
5058  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
5059  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
5060  *	should set this flag for now.
5061  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
5062  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
5063  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
5064  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
5065  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
5066  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5067  *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5068  * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5069  */
5070 enum wiphy_flags {
5071 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
5072 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
5073 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
5074 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
5075 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
5076 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
5077 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
5078 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
5079 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
5080 	WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT			= BIT(9),
5081 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
5082 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
5083 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
5084 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
5085 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
5086 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
5087 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
5088 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
5089 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
5090 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
5091 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
5092 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
5093 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
5094 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
5095 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
5096 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
5097 };
5098 
5099 /**
5100  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5101  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5102  * @types: interface types (bits)
5103  */
5104 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5105 	u16 max;
5106 	u16 types;
5107 };
5108 
5109 /**
5110  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5111  *
5112  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5113  * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio,
5114  * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on
5115  * that radio.
5116  *
5117  * Examples:
5118  *
5119  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5120  *
5121  *    .. code-block:: c
5122  *
5123  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5124  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5125  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5126  *	};
5127  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5128  *		.limits = limits1,
5129  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5130  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5131  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5132  *	};
5133  *
5134  *
5135  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5136  *
5137  *    .. code-block:: c
5138  *
5139  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5140  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5141  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5142  *	};
5143  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5144  *		.limits = limits2,
5145  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5146  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5147  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5148  *	};
5149  *
5150  *
5151  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5152  *
5153  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5154  *
5155  *    .. code-block:: c
5156  *
5157  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5158  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5159  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5160  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5161  *	};
5162  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5163  *		.limits = limits3,
5164  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5165  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5166  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5167  *	};
5168  *
5169  */
5170 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5171 	/**
5172 	 * @limits:
5173 	 * limits for the given interface types
5174 	 */
5175 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5176 
5177 	/**
5178 	 * @num_different_channels:
5179 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5180 	 */
5181 	u32 num_different_channels;
5182 
5183 	/**
5184 	 * @max_interfaces:
5185 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5186 	 */
5187 	u16 max_interfaces;
5188 
5189 	/**
5190 	 * @n_limits:
5191 	 * number of limitations
5192 	 */
5193 	u8 n_limits;
5194 
5195 	/**
5196 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5197 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5198 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5199 	 */
5200 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5201 
5202 	/**
5203 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5204 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5205 	 */
5206 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5207 
5208 	/**
5209 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5210 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5211 	 */
5212 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5213 
5214 	/**
5215 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5216 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5217 	 *
5218 	 * = 0
5219 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5220 	 * > 0
5221 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5222 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5223 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5224 	 */
5225 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5226 };
5227 
5228 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5229 	u16 tx, rx;
5230 };
5231 
5232 /**
5233  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5234  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5235  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5236  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5237  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5238  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5239  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5240  *	(see nl80211.h)
5241  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5242  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5243  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5244  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5245  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5246  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5247  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5248  */
5249 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5250 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5251 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5252 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5253 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5254 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5255 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5256 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5257 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5258 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5259 };
5260 
5261 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5262 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5263 	u32 data_payload_max;
5264 	u32 data_interval_max;
5265 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5266 	bool seq;
5267 };
5268 
5269 /**
5270  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5271  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5272  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5273  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5274  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5275  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5276  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5277  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5278  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5279  *	scheduled scans.
5280  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5281  *	details.
5282  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5283  */
5284 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5285 	u32 flags;
5286 	int n_patterns;
5287 	int pattern_max_len;
5288 	int pattern_min_len;
5289 	int max_pkt_offset;
5290 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5291 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5292 };
5293 
5294 /**
5295  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5296  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5297  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5298  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5299  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5300  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5301  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5302  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5303  */
5304 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5305 	int n_rules;
5306 	int max_delay;
5307 	int n_patterns;
5308 	int pattern_max_len;
5309 	int pattern_min_len;
5310 	int max_pkt_offset;
5311 };
5312 
5313 /**
5314  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5315  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5316  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5317  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5318  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5319  */
5320 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5321 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5322 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5323 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5324 };
5325 
5326 /**
5327  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5328  *
5329  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5330  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5331  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5332  *
5333  */
5334 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5335 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5336 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5337 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5338 };
5339 
5340 /**
5341  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5342  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5343  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5344  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5345  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5346  */
5347 
5348 struct sta_opmode_info {
5349 	u32 changed;
5350 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5351 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5352 	u8 rx_nss;
5353 };
5354 
5355 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5356 
5357 /**
5358  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5359  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5360  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5361  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5362  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5363  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5364  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5365  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5366  *	dumpit calls.
5367  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5368  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5369  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5370  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5371  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5372  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5373  * are used with dump requests.
5374  */
5375 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5376 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5377 	u32 flags;
5378 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5379 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5380 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5381 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5382 		      unsigned long *storage);
5383 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5384 	unsigned int maxattr;
5385 };
5386 
5387 /**
5388  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5389  * @iftype: interface type
5390  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5391  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5392  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5393  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5394  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5395  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5396  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5397  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5398  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5399  */
5400 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5401 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5402 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5403 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5404 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5405 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5406 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5407 };
5408 
5409 /**
5410  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5411  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5412  * @type: the interface type to look up
5413  *
5414  * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5415  */
5416 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5417 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5418 
5419 /**
5420  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5421  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5422  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5423  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5424  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5425  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5426  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5427  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5428  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5429  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5430  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5431  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5432  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5433  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5434  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5435  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5436  *	not limited)
5437  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5438  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5439  */
5440 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5441 	unsigned int max_peers;
5442 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5443 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5444 
5445 	struct {
5446 		u32 preambles;
5447 		u32 bandwidths;
5448 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5449 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5450 		u8 supported:1,
5451 		   asap:1,
5452 		   non_asap:1,
5453 		   request_lci:1,
5454 		   request_civicloc:1,
5455 		   trigger_based:1,
5456 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5457 	} ftm;
5458 };
5459 
5460 /**
5461  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5462  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5463  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5464  *
5465  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5466  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5467  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5468  */
5469 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5470 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5471 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5472 	int n_akm_suites;
5473 };
5474 
5475 /**
5476  * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range
5477  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency (kHz)
5478  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency (kHz)
5479  */
5480 struct wiphy_radio_freq_range {
5481 	u32 start_freq;
5482 	u32 end_freq;
5483 };
5484 
5485 
5486 /**
5487  * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy
5488  * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy.
5489  * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel
5490  * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio.
5491  *
5492  * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on.
5493  * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range
5494  *
5495  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5496  *	list single interface types.
5497  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5498  *
5499  * @antenna_mask: bitmask of antennas connected to this radio.
5500  */
5501 struct wiphy_radio {
5502 	const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range;
5503 	int n_freq_range;
5504 
5505 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5506 	int n_iface_combinations;
5507 
5508 	u32 antenna_mask;
5509 };
5510 
5511 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5512 
5513 /**
5514  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5515  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5516  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5517  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5518  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5519  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5520  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5521  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5522  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5523  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5524  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5525  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5526  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5527  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5528  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5529  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5530  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5531  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5532  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5533  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5534  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5535  *	suites are specified separately.
5536  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5537  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5538  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5539  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5540  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5541  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5542  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5543  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5544  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5545  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5546  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5547  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5548  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5549  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5550  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5551  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5552  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5553  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5554  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5555  *	unregister hardware
5556  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5557  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5558  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5559  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5560  *	(see below).
5561  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5562  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5563  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5564  *	must be set by driver
5565  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5566  *	list single interface types.
5567  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5568  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5569  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5570  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5571  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5572  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5573  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5574  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5575  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5576  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5577  *	this variable determines its size
5578  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5579  *	any given scan
5580  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5581  *	the device can run concurrently.
5582  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5583  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5584  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5585  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5586  *	supported.
5587  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5588  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5589  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5590  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5591  *	scans
5592  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5593  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5594  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5595  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5596  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5597  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5598  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5599  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5600  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5601  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5602  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5603  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5604  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5605  *
5606  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5607  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5608  *	type
5609  *
5610  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5611  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5612  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5613  *
5614  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5615  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5616  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5617  *
5618  * @probe_resp_offload:
5619  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5620  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5621  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5622  *
5623  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5624  *	may request, if implemented.
5625  *
5626  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5627  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5628  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5629  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5630  *
5631  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5632  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5633  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5634  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5635  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5636  *
5637  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5638  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5639  *
5640  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5641  *	supports for ACL.
5642  *
5643  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5644  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5645  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5646  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5647  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5648  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5649  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5650  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5651  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5652  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5653  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5654  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5655  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5656  *
5657  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5658  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5659  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5660  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5661  *
5662  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5663  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5664  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5665  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5666  *
5667  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5668  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5669  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5670  *	infinite.
5671  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5672  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5673  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5674  *
5675  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5676  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5677  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5678  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5679  *
5680  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5681  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5682  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5683  *
5684  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5685  *	wake_tx_queue
5686  *
5687  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5688  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5689  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5690  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5691  *
5692  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5693  *
5694  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5695  *	device has
5696  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5697  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5698  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5699  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5700  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5701  *	long/short retry configuration
5702  *
5703  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5704  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5705  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5706  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5707  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5708  *
5709  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5710  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5711  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5712  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5713  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5714  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5715  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5716  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5717  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5718  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5719  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5720  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5721  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5722  *
5723  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5724  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5725  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5726  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5727  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5728  *	specify a mac address).
5729  *
5730  * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy
5731  * @n_radio: number of radios
5732  */
5733 struct wiphy {
5734 	struct mutex mtx;
5735 
5736 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5737 
5738 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5739 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5740 
5741 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5742 
5743 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5744 
5745 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5746 	int n_iface_combinations;
5747 	u16 software_iftypes;
5748 
5749 	u16 n_addresses;
5750 
5751 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5752 	u16 interface_modes;
5753 
5754 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5755 
5756 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5757 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5758 
5759 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5760 
5761 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5762 
5763 	int bss_priv_size;
5764 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5765 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5766 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5767 	u8 max_match_sets;
5768 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5769 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5770 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5771 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5772 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5773 
5774 	int n_cipher_suites;
5775 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5776 
5777 	int n_akm_suites;
5778 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5779 
5780 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5781 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5782 
5783 	u8 retry_short;
5784 	u8 retry_long;
5785 	u32 frag_threshold;
5786 	u32 rts_threshold;
5787 	u8 coverage_class;
5788 
5789 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5790 	u32 hw_version;
5791 
5792 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5793 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5794 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5795 #endif
5796 
5797 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5798 
5799 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5800 
5801 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5802 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5803 
5804 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5805 
5806 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5807 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5808 
5809 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5810 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5811 
5812 	const void *privid;
5813 
5814 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5815 
5816 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5817 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5818 
5819 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5820 
5821 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5822 
5823 	struct device dev;
5824 
5825 	bool registered;
5826 
5827 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5828 
5829 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5830 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5831 
5832 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5833 
5834 	possible_net_t _net;
5835 
5836 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5837 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5838 #endif
5839 
5840 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5841 
5842 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5843 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5844 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5845 
5846 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5847 
5848 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5849 
5850 	u32 bss_select_support;
5851 
5852 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5853 
5854 	u32 txq_limit;
5855 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5856 	u32 txq_quantum;
5857 
5858 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5859 
5860 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5861 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5862 
5863 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5864 
5865 	struct {
5866 		u64 peer, vif;
5867 		u8 max_retry;
5868 	} tid_config_support;
5869 
5870 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5871 
5872 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5873 
5874 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5875 
5876 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5877 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5878 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5879 
5880 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5881 
5882 	int n_radio;
5883 	const struct wiphy_radio *radio;
5884 
5885 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5886 };
5887 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5888 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5889 {
5890 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5891 }
5892 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5893 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5894 {
5895 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5896 }
5897 
5898 /**
5899  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5900  *
5901  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5902  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5903  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5904 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5905 {
5906 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5907 	return &wiphy->priv;
5908 }
5909 
5910 /**
5911  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5912  *
5913  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5914  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5915  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5916 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5917 {
5918 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5919 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5920 }
5921 
5922 /**
5923  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5924  *
5925  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5926  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5927  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5928 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5929 {
5930 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5931 }
5932 
5933 /**
5934  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5935  *
5936  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5937  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5938  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5939 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5940 {
5941 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5942 }
5943 
5944 /**
5945  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5946  *
5947  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5948  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5949  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5950 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5951 {
5952 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5953 }
5954 
5955 /**
5956  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5957  *
5958  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5959  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5960  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5961  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5962  *
5963  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5964  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5965  *
5966  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5967  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5968  */
5969 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5970 			   const char *requested_name);
5971 
5972 /**
5973  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5974  *
5975  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5976  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5977  *
5978  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5979  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5980  *
5981  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5982  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5983  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5984 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5985 				      int sizeof_priv)
5986 {
5987 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5988 }
5989 
5990 /**
5991  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5992  *
5993  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5994  *
5995  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5996  */
5997 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5998 
5999 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
6000 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
6001 
6002 /**
6003  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
6004  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6005  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6006  *
6007  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
6008  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
6009  */
6010 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
6011         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6012 
6013 /**
6014  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
6015  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6016  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6017  *
6018  * Return: the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
6019  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
6020  */
6021 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
6022         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6023 
6024 /**
6025  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
6026  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
6027  *
6028  * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
6029  *
6030  * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
6031  */
6032 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6033 
6034 /**
6035  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
6036  *
6037  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
6038  *
6039  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
6040  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
6041  * request that is being handled.
6042  */
6043 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6044 
6045 /**
6046  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
6047  *
6048  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
6049  */
6050 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6051 
6052 /* internal structs */
6053 struct cfg80211_conn;
6054 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
6055 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
6056 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
6057 
6058 /**
6059  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
6060  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
6061  *
6062  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
6063  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
6064  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
6065  * differentiate which way it's called.
6066  *
6067  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
6068  *
6069  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
6070  *
6071  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
6072  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
6073  */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6074 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6075 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
6076 {
6077 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
6078 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
6079 }
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
6083  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
6084  */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6085 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6086 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
6087 {
6088 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
6089 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
6090 }
6091 
6092 DEFINE_GUARD(wiphy, struct wiphy *,
6093 	     mutex_lock(&_T->mtx),
6094 	     mutex_unlock(&_T->mtx))
6095 
6096 struct wiphy_work;
6097 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
6098 
6099 struct wiphy_work {
6100 	struct list_head entry;
6101 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
6102 };
6103 
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)6104 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
6105 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6106 {
6107 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
6108 	work->func = func;
6109 }
6110 
6111 /**
6112  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
6113  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6114  * @work: the work item
6115  *
6116  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6117  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6118  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6119  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6120  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6121  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6122  */
6123 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6124 
6125 /**
6126  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6127  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6128  * @work: the work to cancel
6129  *
6130  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6131  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6132  */
6133 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6134 
6135 /**
6136  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6137  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6138  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6139  *
6140  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6141  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6142  */
6143 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6144 
6145 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6146 	struct wiphy_work work;
6147 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6148 	struct timer_list timer;
6149 };
6150 
6151 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6152 
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6153 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6154 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6155 {
6156 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6157 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6158 }
6159 
6160 /**
6161  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6162  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6163  * @dwork: the delayable worker
6164  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6165  *
6166  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6167  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6168  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6169  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6170  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6171  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6172  */
6173 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6174 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6175 			      unsigned long delay);
6176 
6177 /**
6178  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6179  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6180  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6181  *
6182  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6183  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6184  */
6185 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6186 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6187 
6188 /**
6189  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6190  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6191  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6192  *
6193  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6194  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6195  */
6196 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6197 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6198 
6199 /**
6200  * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable
6201  * work item is currently pending.
6202  *
6203  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6204  * @dwork: the delayed work in question
6205  *
6206  * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise
6207  *
6208  * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which
6209  * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work.
6210  * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is
6211  * called twice and the second call happens before the first call
6212  * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and
6213  * won't run before that.
6214  *
6215  * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling
6216  * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule
6217  * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to
6218  * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it
6219  * is currently executing.
6220  *
6221  *      CPU0                                CPU1
6222  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk)
6223  *  mod_timer(wk->timer)
6224  *                                     wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true
6225  *
6226  * [...]
6227  * expire_timers(wk->timer)
6228  *  detach_timer(wk->timer)
6229  *                                     wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false
6230  *  wk->timer->function()                          |
6231  *   wiphy_work_queue(wk)                          | delayed work pending
6232  *    list_add_tail()                              | returns false but
6233  *    queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work)              | wk->func() has not
6234  *                                                 | been run yet
6235  * [...]                                           |
6236  *  cfg80211_wiphy_work()                          |
6237  *   wk->func()                                    V
6238  *
6239  */
6240 bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6241 				struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6242 
6243 /**
6244  * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point
6245  *
6246  * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode
6247  * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point
6248  * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point
6249  * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point
6250  */
6251 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power {
6252 	IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP,
6253 	IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP,
6254 	IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP,
6255 	IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP,
6256 };
6257 
6258 /**
6259  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6260  *
6261  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6262  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6263  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6264  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6265  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6266  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6267  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6268  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6269  *
6270  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6271  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6272  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6273  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6274  *
6275  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6276  * @iftype: interface type
6277  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6278  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6279  *	for the notifier
6280  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6281  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6282  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6283  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6284  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6285  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6286  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6287  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6288  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6289  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6290  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6291  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6292  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6293  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6294  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6295  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6296  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6297  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6298  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6299  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6300  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6301  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6302  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6303  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6304  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6305  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6306  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6307  *	the P2P Device.
6308  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6309  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6310  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6311  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6312  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6313  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6314  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6315  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6316  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6317  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6318  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6319  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6320  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6321  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6322  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6323  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6324  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6325  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6326  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6327  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6328  *	unprotected beacon report
6329  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6330  *	@ap and @client for each link
6331  * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been
6332  *	started
6333  * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was
6334  *	entered.
6335  * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6336  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6337  * @radio_mask: Bitmask of radios that this interface is allowed to operate on.
6338  */
6339 struct wireless_dev {
6340 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6341 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6342 
6343 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6344 	struct list_head list;
6345 	struct net_device *netdev;
6346 
6347 	u32 identifier;
6348 
6349 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6350 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6351 
6352 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6353 
6354 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6355 
6356 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6357 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6358 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6359 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6360 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6361 
6362 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6363 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6364 
6365 	struct list_head event_list;
6366 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6367 
6368 	u8 connected:1;
6369 
6370 	bool ps;
6371 	int ps_timeout;
6372 
6373 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6374 
6375 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6376 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6377 
6378 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6379 	/* wext data */
6380 	struct {
6381 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6382 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6383 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6384 		const u8 *ie;
6385 		size_t ie_len;
6386 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6387 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6388 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6389 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6390 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6391 	} wext;
6392 #endif
6393 
6394 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6395 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6396 
6397 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6398 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6399 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6400 
6401 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6402 
6403 	union {
6404 		struct {
6405 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6406 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6407 			u8 ssid_len;
6408 		} client;
6409 		struct {
6410 			int beacon_interval;
6411 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6412 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6413 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6414 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6415 		} mesh;
6416 		struct {
6417 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6418 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6419 			u8 ssid_len;
6420 		} ap;
6421 		struct {
6422 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6423 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6424 			int beacon_interval;
6425 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6426 			u8 ssid_len;
6427 		} ibss;
6428 		struct {
6429 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6430 		} ocb;
6431 	} u;
6432 
6433 	struct {
6434 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6435 		union {
6436 			struct {
6437 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6438 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6439 			} ap;
6440 			struct {
6441 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6442 			} client;
6443 		};
6444 
6445 		bool cac_started;
6446 		unsigned long cac_start_time;
6447 		unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6448 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6449 	u16 valid_links;
6450 
6451 	u32 radio_mask;
6452 };
6453 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6454 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6455 {
6456 	if (wdev->netdev)
6457 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6458 	return wdev->address;
6459 }
6460 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6461 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6462 {
6463 	if (wdev->netdev)
6464 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6465 	return wdev->is_running;
6466 }
6467 
6468 /**
6469  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6470  *
6471  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6472  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6473  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6474 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6475 {
6476 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6477 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6478 }
6479 
6480 /**
6481  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6482  * @wdev: the wdev
6483  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6484  *
6485  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6486  */
6487 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6488 				       unsigned int link_id);
6489 
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6490 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6491 					unsigned int link_id)
6492 {
6493 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6494 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6495 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6496 }
6497 
6498 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6499 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6500 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6501 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6502 	     link_id++)						\
6503 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6504 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6505 
6506 /**
6507  * DOC: Utility functions
6508  *
6509  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6510  */
6511 
6512 /**
6513  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6514  *
6515  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6516  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6517  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6518  */
6519 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6520 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6521 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6522 {
6523 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6524 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6525 }
6526 
6527 /**
6528  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6529  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6530  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6531  */
6532 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6533 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6534 {
6535 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6536 }
6537 
6538 /**
6539  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6540  *
6541  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6542  * @chan: channel
6543  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6544  */
6545 enum nl80211_chan_width
6546 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6547 
6548 /**
6549  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6550  * @chan: channel number
6551  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6552  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6553  */
6554 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6555 
6556 /**
6557  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6558  * @chan: channel number
6559  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6560  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6561  */
6562 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6563 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6564 {
6565 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6566 }
6567 
6568 /**
6569  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6570  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6571  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6572  */
6573 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6574 
6575 /**
6576  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6577  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6578  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6579  */
6580 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6581 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6582 {
6583 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6584 }
6585 
6586 /**
6587  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6588  * frequency
6589  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6590  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6591  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6592  */
6593 struct ieee80211_channel *
6594 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6595 
6596 /**
6597  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6598  *
6599  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6600  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6601  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6602  */
6603 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6604 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6605 {
6606 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6607 }
6608 
6609 /**
6610  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6611  * @chan: control channel to check
6612  *
6613  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6614  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6615  *
6616  * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6617  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6618 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6619 {
6620 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6621 		return false;
6622 
6623 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6624 }
6625 
6626 /**
6627  * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef
6628  *
6629  * @radio: wiphy radio
6630  * @chandef: chandef for current channel
6631  *
6632  * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio
6633  */
6634 bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio,
6635 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
6636 
6637 /**
6638  * cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed - Check if the wdev may use the channel
6639  *
6640  * @wdev: the wireless device
6641  * @chan: channel to check
6642  *
6643  * Return: whether or not the wdev may use the channel
6644  */
6645 bool cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6646 				   struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6647 
6648 /**
6649  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6650  *
6651  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6652  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6653  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6654  *
6655  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6656  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6657  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6658  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6659  */
6660 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6661 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6662 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6663 
6664 /**
6665  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6666  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6667  *
6668  * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6669  * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6670  */
6671 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6672 
6673 /*
6674  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6675  *
6676  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6677  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6678  */
6679 
6680 struct radiotap_align_size {
6681 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6682 };
6683 
6684 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6685 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6686 	int n_bits;
6687 	uint32_t oui;
6688 	uint8_t subns;
6689 };
6690 
6691 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6692 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6693 	int n_ns;
6694 };
6695 
6696 /**
6697  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6698  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6699  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6700  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6701  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6702  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6703  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6704  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6705  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6706  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6707  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6708  *	radiotap namespace or not
6709  *
6710  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6711  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6712  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6713  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6714  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6715  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6716  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6717  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6718  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6719  *	next bitmap word
6720  *
6721  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6722  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6723  */
6724 
6725 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6726 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6727 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6728 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6729 
6730 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6731 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6732 
6733 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6734 	int this_arg_index;
6735 	int this_arg_size;
6736 
6737 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6738 
6739 	int _max_length;
6740 	int _arg_index;
6741 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6742 	int _reset_on_ext;
6743 };
6744 
6745 int
6746 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6747 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6748 				 int max_length,
6749 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6750 
6751 int
6752 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6753 
6754 
6755 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6756 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6757 
6758 /**
6759  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6760  *
6761  * @skb: the frame
6762  *
6763  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6764  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6765  *
6766  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6767  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6768  * 802.11 header.
6769  */
6770 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6771 
6772 /**
6773  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6774  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6775  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6776  */
6777 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6778 
6779 /**
6780  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6781  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6782  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6783  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6784  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6785  */
6786 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6787 
6788 /**
6789  * DOC: Data path helpers
6790  *
6791  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6792  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6793  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6794  */
6795 
6796 /**
6797  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6798  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6799  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6800  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6801  * @addr: the device MAC address
6802  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6803  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6804  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6805  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6806  */
6807 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6808 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6809 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6810 
6811 /**
6812  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6813  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6814  * @addr: the device MAC address
6815  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6816  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6817  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6818 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6819 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6820 {
6821 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6822 }
6823 
6824 /**
6825  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6826  *
6827  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6828  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6829  * mesh control field.
6830  *
6831  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6832  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6833  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6834  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6835  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6836  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6837  */
6838 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6839 
6840 /**
6841  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6842  *
6843  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6844  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6845  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6846  *
6847  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6848  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6849  *	initialized by the caller.
6850  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6851  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6852  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6853  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6854  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6855  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6856  */
6857 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6858 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6859 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6860 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6861 			      u8 mesh_control);
6862 
6863 /**
6864  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6865  *
6866  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6867  * protocol.
6868  *
6869  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6870  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6871  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6872  */
6873 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6874 
6875 /**
6876  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6877  *
6878  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6879  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6880  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6881  *
6882  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6883  *
6884  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6885  */
6886 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6887 
6888 /**
6889  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6890  * @skb: the data frame
6891  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6892  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6893  */
6894 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6895 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6896 
6897 /**
6898  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6899  *
6900  * @eid: element ID
6901  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6902  * @len: length of data
6903  * @match: byte array to match
6904  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6905  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6906  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6907  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6908  *	the data portion instead.
6909  *
6910  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6911  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6912  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6913  * requested element struct.
6914  *
6915  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6916  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6917  * byte array to match.
6918  */
6919 const struct element *
6920 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6921 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6922 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6923 
6924 /**
6925  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6926  *
6927  * @eid: element ID
6928  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6929  * @len: length of data
6930  * @match: byte array to match
6931  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6932  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6933  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6934  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6935  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6936  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6937  *
6938  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6939  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6940  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6941  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6942  * element ID.
6943  *
6944  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6945  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6946  * byte array to match.
6947  */
6948 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6949 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6950 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6951 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6952 {
6953 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6954 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6955 	 */
6956 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6957 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6958 		return NULL;
6959 
6960 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6961 						      match, match_len,
6962 						      match_offset ?
6963 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6964 }
6965 
6966 /**
6967  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6968  *
6969  * @eid: element ID
6970  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6971  * @len: length of data
6972  *
6973  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6974  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6975  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6976  * requested element struct.
6977  *
6978  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6979  * having to fit into the given data.
6980  */
6981 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6982 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6983 {
6984 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6985 }
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6989  *
6990  * @eid: element ID
6991  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6992  * @len: length of data
6993  *
6994  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6995  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6996  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6997  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6998  *
6999  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7000  * having to fit into the given data.
7001  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7002 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7003 {
7004 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
7005 }
7006 
7007 /**
7008  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
7009  *
7010  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7011  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7012  * @len: length of data
7013  *
7014  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
7015  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7016  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
7017  * requested element struct.
7018  *
7019  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7020  * having to fit into the given data.
7021  */
7022 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7023 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7024 {
7025 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7026 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
7027 }
7028 
7029 /**
7030  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
7031  *
7032  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7033  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7034  * @len: length of data
7035  *
7036  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
7037  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7038  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7039  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7040  *
7041  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7042  * having to fit into the given data.
7043  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7044 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7045 {
7046 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7047 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
7048 }
7049 
7050 /**
7051  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
7052  *
7053  * @oui: vendor OUI
7054  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7055  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7056  * @len: length of data
7057  *
7058  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7059  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
7060  * return the element structure for the requested element.
7061  *
7062  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7063  * the given data.
7064  */
7065 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7066 						const u8 *ies,
7067 						unsigned int len);
7068 
7069 /**
7070  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
7071  *
7072  * @oui: vendor OUI
7073  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7074  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7075  * @len: length of data
7076  *
7077  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7078  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
7079  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
7080  * element ID.
7081  *
7082  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7083  * the given data.
7084  */
7085 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)7086 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7087 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
7088 {
7089 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
7090 }
7091 
7092 /**
7093  * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
7094  * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
7095  * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
7096  * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
7097  */
7098 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
7099 	RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
7100 	RNR_ITER_BREAK,
7101 	RNR_ITER_ERROR,
7102 };
7103 
7104 /**
7105  * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
7106  * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
7107  *	their entries in
7108  * @elems_len: length of the elements
7109  * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7110  *	for the return value
7111  * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
7112  * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
7113  *	or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
7114  *	%false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
7115  *	or elements were malformed.)
7116  */
7117 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
7118 		       enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7119 		       (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
7120 			       const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
7121 			       const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
7122 		       void *iter_data);
7123 
7124 /**
7125  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
7126  *
7127  * @elem: the element to defragment
7128  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
7129  * @ieslen: length of @ies
7130  * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
7131  * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
7132  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
7133  *
7134  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
7135  *
7136  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
7137  * skipping all headers.
7138  *
7139  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
7140  * element in-place.
7141  */
7142 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
7143 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
7144 				    u8 frag_id);
7145 
7146 /**
7147  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
7148  *
7149  * @dev: network device
7150  * @addr: STA MAC address
7151  *
7152  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
7153  * devices upon STA association.
7154  */
7155 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7156 
7157 /**
7158  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
7159  *
7160  * TODO
7161  */
7162 
7163 /**
7164  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
7165  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
7166  *	conflicts)
7167  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
7168  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
7169  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
7170  *	alpha2.
7171  *
7172  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
7173  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
7174  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
7175  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
7176  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
7177  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
7178  *
7179  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
7180  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
7181  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
7182  *
7183  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7184  * an -ENOMEM.
7185  *
7186  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
7187  */
7188 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
7189 
7190 /**
7191  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
7192  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7193  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7194  *
7195  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
7196  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
7197  * information.
7198  *
7199  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7200  */
7201 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7202 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7203 
7204 /**
7205  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7206  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7207  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7208  *
7209  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7210  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7211  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7212  *
7213  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7214  */
7215 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7216 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7217 
7218 /**
7219  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7220  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7221  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7222  *
7223  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7224  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7225  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7226  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7227  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7228  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7229  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7230  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7231  * that called this helper.
7232  */
7233 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7234 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7235 
7236 /**
7237  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7238  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7239  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7240  *
7241  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7242  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7243  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7244  * and processed already.
7245  *
7246  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7247  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7248  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7249  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7250  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7251  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7252  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7253  */
7254 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7255 					       u32 center_freq);
7256 
7257 /**
7258  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7259  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7260  *
7261  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7262  * proper string representation.
7263  *
7264  * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7265  */
7266 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7267 
7268 /**
7269  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7270  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7271  *
7272  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7273  *
7274  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7275  */
7276 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7277 
7278 /**
7279  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7280  *
7281  */
7282 
7283 /**
7284  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7285  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7286  *
7287  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7288  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7289  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7290  *
7291  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7292  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7293  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7294  *
7295  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7296  * an -ENODATA.
7297  *
7298  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7299  */
7300 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7301 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7302 
7303 /*
7304  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7305  * functions and BSS handling helpers
7306  */
7307 
7308 /**
7309  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7310  *
7311  * @request: the corresponding scan request
7312  * @info: information about the completed scan
7313  */
7314 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7315 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7319  *
7320  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7321  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7322  */
7323 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7324 
7325 /**
7326  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7327  *
7328  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7329  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7330  *
7331  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7332  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7333  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7334  */
7335 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7336 
7337 /**
7338  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7339  *
7340  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7341  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7342  *
7343  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7344  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7345  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7346  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7347  */
7348 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7349 
7350 /**
7351  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7352  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7353  * @data: the BSS metadata
7354  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7355  * @len: length of the management frame
7356  * @gfp: context flags
7357  *
7358  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7359  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7360  *
7361  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7362  * Or %NULL on error.
7363  */
7364 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7365 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7366 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7367 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7368 			       gfp_t gfp);
7369 
7370 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7371 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7372 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7373 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7374 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7375 {
7376 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7377 		.chan = rx_channel,
7378 		.signal = signal,
7379 	};
7380 
7381 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7382 }
7383 
7384 /**
7385  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7386  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7387  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7388  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7389  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7390  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7391 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7392 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7393 {
7394 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7395 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7396 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7397 
7398 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7399 
7400 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7401 
7402 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7403 }
7404 
7405 /**
7406  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7407  * @element: element to check
7408  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7409  *
7410  * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7411  */
7412 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7413 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7414 
7415 /**
7416  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7417  * @ie: ies
7418  * @ielen: length of IEs
7419  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7420  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7421  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7422  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7423  *
7424  * Return: the number of bytes merged
7425  */
7426 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7427 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7428 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7429 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7430 
7431 /**
7432  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7433  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7434  *	from a beacon or probe response
7435  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7436  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7437  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7438  */
7439 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7440 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7441 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7442 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7443 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7444 };
7445 
7446 /**
7447  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7448  * @ie: IEs
7449  * @ielen: length of IEs
7450  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7451  *
7452  * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7453  */
7454 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7455 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7456 
7457 /**
7458  * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7459  * @a: first SSID
7460  * @b: second SSID
7461  *
7462  * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7463  */
7464 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7465 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7466 {
7467 	if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7468 		return false;
7469 	if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7470 		return false;
7471 	return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7472 }
7473 
7474 /**
7475  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7476  *
7477  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7478  * @data: the BSS metadata
7479  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7480  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7481  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7482  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7483  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7484  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7485  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7486  * @gfp: context flags
7487  *
7488  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7489  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7490  *
7491  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7492  * Or %NULL on error.
7493  */
7494 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7495 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7496 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7497 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7498 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7499 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7500 			 gfp_t gfp);
7501 
7502 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7503 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7504 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7505 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7506 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7507 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7508 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7509 {
7510 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7511 		.chan = rx_channel,
7512 		.signal = signal,
7513 	};
7514 
7515 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7516 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7517 					gfp);
7518 }
7519 
7520 /**
7521  * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7522  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7523  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7524  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7525  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7526  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7527  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7528  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7529  * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7530  *
7531  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7532  */
7533 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7534 					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7535 					const u8 *bssid,
7536 					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7537 					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7538 					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7539 					u32 use_for);
7540 
7541 /**
7542  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7543  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7544  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7545  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7546  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7547  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7548  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7549  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7550  *
7551  * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7552  *
7553  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7554  */
7555 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7556 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7557 		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7558 		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7559 		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7560 {
7561 	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7562 				  bss_type, privacy,
7563 				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7564 }
7565 
7566 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7567 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7568 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7569 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7570 {
7571 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7572 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7573 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7574 }
7575 
7576 /**
7577  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7578  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7579  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7580  *
7581  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7582  */
7583 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7584 
7585 /**
7586  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7587  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7588  * @bss: the BSS struct
7589  *
7590  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7591  */
7592 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7593 
7594 /**
7595  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7596  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7597  * @bss: the bss to remove
7598  *
7599  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7600  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7601  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7602  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7603  */
7604 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7605 
7606 /**
7607  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7608  *
7609  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7610  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7611  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7612  *
7613  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7614  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7615  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7616  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7617  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7618  */
7619 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7620 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7621 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7622 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7623 				    void *data),
7624 		       void *iter_data);
7625 
7626 /**
7627  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7628  * @dev: network device
7629  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7630  * @len: length of the frame data
7631  *
7632  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7633  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7634  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7635  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7636  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7637  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7638  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7639  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7640  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7641  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7642  *
7643  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7644  */
7645 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7646 
7647 /**
7648  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7649  * @dev: network device
7650  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7651  *
7652  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7653  * mutex.
7654  */
7655 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7656 
7657 /**
7658  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7659  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7660  * @len: length of the frame data
7661  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7662  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7663  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7664  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7665  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7666  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7667  *	non-MLO connections
7668  * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7669  *      pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7670  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7671  *	were rejected by the AP.
7672  */
7673 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7674 	const u8 *buf;
7675 	size_t len;
7676 	const u8 *req_ies;
7677 	size_t req_ies_len;
7678 	int uapsd_queues;
7679 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7680 	struct {
7681 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7682 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7683 		u16 status;
7684 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7685 };
7686 
7687 /**
7688  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7689  * @dev: network device
7690  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7691  *
7692  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7693  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7694  *
7695  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7696  */
7697 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7698 			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7699 
7700 /**
7701  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7702  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7703  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7704  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7705  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7706  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7707  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7708  */
7709 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7710 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7711 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7712 	bool timeout;
7713 };
7714 
7715 /**
7716  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7717  * @dev: network device
7718  * @data: data describing the association failure
7719  *
7720  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7721  */
7722 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7723 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7724 
7725 /**
7726  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7727  * @dev: network device
7728  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7729  * @len: length of the frame data
7730  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7731  *
7732  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7733  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7734  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7735  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7736  */
7737 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7738 			   bool reconnect);
7739 
7740 /**
7741  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7742  * @dev: network device
7743  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7744  * @len: length of the frame data
7745  *
7746  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7747  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7748  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7749  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7750  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7751  *
7752  * This function may sleep.
7753  */
7754 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7755 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7756 
7757 /**
7758  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7759  * @dev: network device
7760  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7761  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7762  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7763  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7764  * @gfp: allocation flags
7765  *
7766  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7767  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7768  * primitive.
7769  */
7770 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7771 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7772 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7773 
7774 /**
7775  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7776  *
7777  * @dev: network device
7778  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7779  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7780  * @gfp: allocation flags
7781  *
7782  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7783  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7784  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7785  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7786  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7787  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7788  */
7789 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7790 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7791 
7792 /**
7793  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7794  * 					candidate
7795  *
7796  * @dev: network device
7797  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7798  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7799  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7800  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7801  * @gfp: allocation flags
7802  *
7803  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7804  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7805  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7806  */
7807 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7808 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7809 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7810 
7811 /**
7812  * DOC: RFkill integration
7813  *
7814  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7815  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7816  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7817  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7818  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7819  *
7820  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7821  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7822  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7823  */
7824 
7825 /**
7826  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7827  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7828  * @blocked: block status
7829  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7830  */
7831 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7832 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7833 
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7834 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7835 {
7836 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7837 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7838 }
7839 
7840 /**
7841  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7842  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7843  */
7844 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7845 
7846 /**
7847  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7848  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7849  */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7850 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7851 {
7852 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7853 }
7854 
7855 /**
7856  * DOC: Vendor commands
7857  *
7858  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7859  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7860  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7861  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7862  * the configuration mechanism.
7863  *
7864  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7865  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7866  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7867  *
7868  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7869  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7870  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7871  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7872  * managers etc. need.
7873  */
7874 
7875 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7876 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7877 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7878 					   int approxlen);
7879 
7880 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7881 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7882 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7883 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7884 					   unsigned int portid,
7885 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7886 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7887 
7888 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7889 
7890 /**
7891  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7892  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7893  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7894  *	be put into the skb
7895  *
7896  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7897  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7898  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7899  *
7900  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7901  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7902  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7903  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7904  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7905  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7906  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7907  *
7908  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7909  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7910  *
7911  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7912  */
7913 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7914 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7915 {
7916 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7917 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7918 }
7919 
7920 /**
7921  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7922  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7923  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7924  *
7925  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7926  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7927  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7928  * skb regardless of the return value.
7929  *
7930  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7931  */
7932 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7933 
7934 /**
7935  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7936  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7937  *
7938  * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7939  *
7940  * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7941  */
7942 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7943 
7944 /**
7945  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7946  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7947  * @wdev: the wireless device
7948  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7949  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7950  *	be put into the skb
7951  * @gfp: allocation flags
7952  *
7953  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7954  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7955  *
7956  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7957  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7958  * attribute.
7959  *
7960  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7961  * skb to send the event.
7962  *
7963  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7964  */
7965 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7966 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7967 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7968 {
7969 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7970 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7971 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7972 }
7973 
7974 /**
7975  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7976  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7977  * @wdev: the wireless device
7978  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7979  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7980  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7981  *	be put into the skb
7982  * @gfp: allocation flags
7983  *
7984  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7985  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7986  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7987  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7988  *
7989  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7990  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7991  * attribute.
7992  *
7993  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7994  * skb to send the event.
7995  *
7996  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7997  */
7998 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7999 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8000 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8001 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
8002 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
8003 {
8004 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
8005 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
8006 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
8007 }
8008 
8009 /**
8010  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
8011  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
8012  * @gfp: allocation flags
8013  *
8014  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8015  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
8016  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8017 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8018 {
8019 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8020 }
8021 
8022 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
8023 /**
8024  * DOC: Test mode
8025  *
8026  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
8027  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
8028  * factory programming.
8029  *
8030  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
8031  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
8032  */
8033 
8034 /**
8035  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
8036  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8037  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8038  *	be put into the skb
8039  *
8040  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
8041  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
8042  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
8043  *
8044  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
8045  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
8046  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
8047  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
8048  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
8049  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
8050  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
8051  *
8052  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
8053  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
8054  *
8055  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8056  */
8057 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)8058 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
8059 {
8060 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8061 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
8062 }
8063 
8064 /**
8065  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
8066  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8067  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
8068  *
8069  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
8070  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
8071  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
8072  * regardless of the return value.
8073  *
8074  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
8075  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)8076 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
8077 {
8078 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
8079 }
8080 
8081 /**
8082  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
8083  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8084  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8085  *	be put into the skb
8086  * @gfp: allocation flags
8087  *
8088  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
8089  * testmode multicast group.
8090  *
8091  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
8092  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
8093  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
8094  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
8095  * in any other way.
8096  *
8097  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
8098  * skb to send the event.
8099  *
8100  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8101  */
8102 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)8103 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
8104 {
8105 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8106 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
8107 					  approxlen, gfp);
8108 }
8109 
8110 /**
8111  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
8112  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8113  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
8114  * @gfp: allocation flags
8115  *
8116  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8117  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
8118  * consumes it.
8119  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8120 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8121 {
8122 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8123 }
8124 
8125 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
8126 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
8127 #else
8128 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
8129 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
8130 #endif
8131 
8132 /**
8133  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
8134  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
8135  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
8136  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
8137  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
8138  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
8139  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
8140  *	status for a FILS connection.
8141  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8142  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
8143  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
8144  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8145  */
8146 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
8147 	const u8 *kek;
8148 	size_t kek_len;
8149 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
8150 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
8151 	const u8 *pmk;
8152 	size_t pmk_len;
8153 	const u8 *pmkid;
8154 };
8155 
8156 /**
8157  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
8158  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8159  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8160  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8161  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8162  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8163  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8164  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8165  *	case.
8166  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
8167  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
8168  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8169  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
8170  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
8171  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8172  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8173  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8174  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8175  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8176  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8177  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
8178  *	zero.
8179  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8180  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
8181  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
8182  *	connected AP info.
8183  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
8184  *	%NULL.
8185  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
8186  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
8187  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
8188  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
8189  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
8190  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
8191  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
8192  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
8193  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
8194  *	to be specified.
8195  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
8196  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
8197  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
8198  */
8199 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8200 	int status;
8201 	const u8 *req_ie;
8202 	size_t req_ie_len;
8203 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8204 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8205 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8206 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8207 
8208 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8209 	u16 valid_links;
8210 	struct {
8211 		const u8 *addr;
8212 		const u8 *bssid;
8213 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8214 		u16 status;
8215 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8216 };
8217 
8218 /**
8219  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8220  *
8221  * @dev: network device
8222  * @params: connection response parameters
8223  * @gfp: allocation flags
8224  *
8225  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8226  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8227  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8228  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8229  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8230  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8231  */
8232 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8233 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8234 			   gfp_t gfp);
8235 
8236 /**
8237  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8238  *
8239  * @dev: network device
8240  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8241  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8242  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8243  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8244  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8245  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8246  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8247  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8248  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8249  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8250  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8251  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8252  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8253  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8254  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8255  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8256  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8257  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8258  *	case.
8259  * @gfp: allocation flags
8260  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8261  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8262  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8263  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8264  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8265  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8266  *
8267  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8268  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8269  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8270  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8271  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8272  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8273  */
8274 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8275 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8276 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8277 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8278 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8279 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8280 {
8281 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8282 
8283 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
8284 	params.status = status;
8285 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8286 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
8287 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
8288 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8289 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8290 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8291 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8292 
8293 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
8294 }
8295 
8296 /**
8297  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8298  *
8299  * @dev: network device
8300  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8301  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8302  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8303  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8304  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8305  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8306  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8307  *	the real status code for failures.
8308  * @gfp: allocation flags
8309  *
8310  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8311  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8312  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8313  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8314  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8315  */
8316 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8317 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8318 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8319 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8320 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8321 {
8322 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8323 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8324 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8325 }
8326 
8327 /**
8328  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8329  *
8330  * @dev: network device
8331  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8332  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8333  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8334  * @gfp: allocation flags
8335  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8336  *
8337  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8338  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8339  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8340  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8341  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8342  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8343  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8344  */
8345 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8346 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8347 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8348 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8349 {
8350 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8351 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8352 }
8353 
8354 /**
8355  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8356  *
8357  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8358  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8359  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8360  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8361  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8362  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8363  *	Otherwise zero.
8364  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8365  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8366  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8367  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8368  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8369  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8370  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8371  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8372  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8373  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8374  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8375  */
8376 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8377 	const u8 *req_ie;
8378 	size_t req_ie_len;
8379 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8380 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8381 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8382 
8383 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8384 	u16 valid_links;
8385 	struct {
8386 		const u8 *addr;
8387 		const u8 *bssid;
8388 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8389 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8390 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8391 };
8392 
8393 /**
8394  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8395  *
8396  * @dev: network device
8397  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8398  * @gfp: allocation flags
8399  *
8400  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8401  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8402  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8403  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8404  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8405  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8406  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8407  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8408  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8409  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8410  */
8411 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8412 		     gfp_t gfp);
8413 
8414 /**
8415  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8416  *
8417  * @dev: network device
8418  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8419  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8420  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8421  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8422  * @gfp: allocation flags
8423  *
8424  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8425  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8426  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8427  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8428  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8429  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8430  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8431  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8432  * associated STA/GC.
8433  */
8434 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8435 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8436 
8437 /**
8438  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8439  *
8440  * @dev: network device
8441  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8442  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8443  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8444  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8445  * @gfp: allocation flags
8446  *
8447  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8448  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8449  */
8450 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8451 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8452 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8453 
8454 /**
8455  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8456  * @wdev: wireless device
8457  * @cookie: the request cookie
8458  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8459  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8460  *	channel
8461  * @gfp: allocation flags
8462  */
8463 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8464 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8465 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8466 
8467 /**
8468  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8469  * @wdev: wireless device
8470  * @cookie: the request cookie
8471  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8472  * @gfp: allocation flags
8473  */
8474 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8475 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8476 					gfp_t gfp);
8477 
8478 /**
8479  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8480  * @wdev: wireless device
8481  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8482  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8483  * @gfp: allocation flags
8484  */
8485 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8486 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8487 
8488 /**
8489  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8490  *
8491  * @sinfo: the station information
8492  * @gfp: allocation flags
8493  *
8494  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8495  */
8496 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8497 
8498 /**
8499  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8500  * @sinfo: the station information
8501  *
8502  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8503  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8504  * the stack.)
8505  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8506 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8507 {
8508 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8509 }
8510 
8511 /**
8512  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8513  *
8514  * @dev: the netdev
8515  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8516  * @sinfo: the station information
8517  * @gfp: allocation flags
8518  */
8519 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8520 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8521 
8522 /**
8523  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8524  * @dev: the netdev
8525  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8526  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8527  * @gfp: allocation flags
8528  */
8529 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8530 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8531 
8532 /**
8533  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8534  *
8535  * @dev: the netdev
8536  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8537  * @gfp: allocation flags
8538  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8539 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8540 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8541 {
8542 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8543 }
8544 
8545 /**
8546  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8547  *
8548  * @dev: the netdev
8549  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8550  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8551  * @gfp: allocation flags
8552  *
8553  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8554  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8555  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8556  *
8557  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8558  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8559  */
8560 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8561 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8562 			  gfp_t gfp);
8563 
8564 /**
8565  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8566  *
8567  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8568  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8569  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8570  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8571  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8572  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8573  * @len: length of the frame data
8574  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8575  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8576  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8577  */
8578 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8579 	int freq;
8580 	int sig_dbm;
8581 	bool have_link_id;
8582 	u8 link_id;
8583 	const u8 *buf;
8584 	size_t len;
8585 	u32 flags;
8586 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8587 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8588 };
8589 
8590 /**
8591  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8592  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8593  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8594  *
8595  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8596  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8597  *
8598  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8599  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8600  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8601  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8602  */
8603 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8604 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8605 
8606 /**
8607  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8608  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8609  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8610  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8611  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8612  * @len: length of the frame data
8613  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8614  *
8615  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8616  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8617  *
8618  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8619  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8620  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8621  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8622  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8623 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8624 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8625 					u32 flags)
8626 {
8627 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8628 		.freq = freq,
8629 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8630 		.buf = buf,
8631 		.len = len,
8632 		.flags = flags
8633 	};
8634 
8635 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8636 }
8637 
8638 /**
8639  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8640  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8641  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8642  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8643  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8644  * @len: length of the frame data
8645  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8646  *
8647  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8648  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8649  *
8650  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8651  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8652  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8653  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8654  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8655 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8656 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8657 				    u32 flags)
8658 {
8659 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8660 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8661 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8662 		.buf = buf,
8663 		.len = len,
8664 		.flags = flags
8665 	};
8666 
8667 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8668 }
8669 
8670 /**
8671  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8672  *
8673  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8674  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8675  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8676  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8677  * @len: length of the frame data
8678  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8679  */
8680 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8681 	u64 cookie;
8682 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8683 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8684 	const u8 *buf;
8685 	size_t len;
8686 	bool ack;
8687 };
8688 
8689 /**
8690  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8691  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8692  * @status: TX status data
8693  * @gfp: context flags
8694  *
8695  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8696  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8697  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8698  */
8699 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8700 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8701 
8702 /**
8703  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8704  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8705  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8706  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8707  * @len: length of the frame data
8708  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8709  * @gfp: context flags
8710  *
8711  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8712  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8713  * transmission attempt.
8714  */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8715 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8716 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8717 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8718 {
8719 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8720 		.cookie = cookie,
8721 		.buf = buf,
8722 		.len = len,
8723 		.ack = ack
8724 	};
8725 
8726 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8727 }
8728 
8729 /**
8730  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8731  *                                   port frames
8732  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8733  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8734  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8735  * @len: length of the frame data
8736  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8737  * @gfp: context flags
8738  *
8739  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8740  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8741  * the transmission attempt.
8742  */
8743 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8744 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8745 				     gfp_t gfp);
8746 
8747 /**
8748  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8749  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8750  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8751  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8752  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8753  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8754  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8755  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8756  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8757  *
8758  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8759  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8760  * control port frames over nl80211.
8761  *
8762  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8763  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8764  *
8765  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8766  */
8767 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8768 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8769 
8770 /**
8771  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8772  * @dev: network device
8773  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8774  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8775  * @gfp: context flags
8776  *
8777  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8778  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8779  */
8780 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8781 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8782 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8783 
8784 /**
8785  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8786  * @dev: network device
8787  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8788  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8789  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8790  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8791  * @gfp: context flags
8792  */
8793 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8794 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8795 
8796 /**
8797  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8798  * @dev: network device
8799  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8800  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8801  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8802  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8803  * @gfp: context flags
8804  *
8805  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8806  * given interval is exceeded.
8807  */
8808 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8809 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8810 
8811 /**
8812  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8813  * @dev: network device
8814  * @gfp: context flags
8815  *
8816  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8817  */
8818 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8819 
8820 /**
8821  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8822  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8823  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8824  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8825  * @gfp: context flags
8826  *
8827  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8828  */
8829 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8830 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8831 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8832 
8833 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8834 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8835 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8836 		     gfp_t gfp)
8837 {
8838 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8839 }
8840 
8841 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8842 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8843 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8844 				gfp_t gfp)
8845 {
8846 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8847 }
8848 
8849 /**
8850  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8851  * @dev: network device
8852  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8853  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8854  * @gfp: context flags
8855  *
8856  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8857  * frame.
8858  */
8859 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8860 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8861 				       gfp_t gfp);
8862 
8863 /**
8864  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8865  * @netdev: network device
8866  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8867  * @event: type of event
8868  * @gfp: context flags
8869  * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise.
8870  *
8871  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8872  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8873  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8874  */
8875 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8876 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8877 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp,
8878 			unsigned int link_id);
8879 
8880 /**
8881  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8882  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8883  *
8884  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8885  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8886  */
8887 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8888 
8889 /**
8890  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8891  * @dev: network device
8892  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8893  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8894  * @gfp: allocation flags
8895  */
8896 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8897 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8898 
8899 /**
8900  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8901  * @dev: network device
8902  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8903  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8904  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8905  * @gfp: allocation flags
8906  */
8907 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8908 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8909 
8910 /**
8911  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8912  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8913  * @addr: the transmitter address
8914  * @gfp: context flags
8915  *
8916  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8917  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8918  * sender.
8919  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8920  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8921  */
8922 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8923 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8924 
8925 /**
8926  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8927  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8928  * @addr: the transmitter address
8929  * @gfp: context flags
8930  *
8931  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8932  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8933  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8934  * station to avoid event flooding.
8935  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8936  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8937  */
8938 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8939 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8940 
8941 /**
8942  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8943  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8944  * @addr: the address of the peer
8945  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8946  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8947  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8948  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8949  * @gfp: allocation flags
8950  */
8951 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8952 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8953 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8954 
8955 /**
8956  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8957  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8958  * @frame: the frame
8959  * @len: length of the frame
8960  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8961  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8962  *
8963  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8964  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8965  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8966  */
8967 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8968 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8969 
8970 /**
8971  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8972  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8973  * @frame: the frame
8974  * @len: length of the frame
8975  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8976  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8977  *
8978  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8979  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8980  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8981  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8982 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8983 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8984 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8985 {
8986 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8987 					sig_dbm);
8988 }
8989 
8990 /**
8991  * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration
8992  * @iftype: the interface type to check for
8993  * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another
8994  *	interface connected already on the same channel)
8995  *	NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held.
8996  * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the
8997  *	advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting
8998  */
8999 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config {
9000 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
9001 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power;
9002 	bool relax;
9003 };
9004 
9005 /**
9006  * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed
9007  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9008  * @chandef: the channel definition
9009  * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking
9010  *
9011  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9012  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9013  */
9014 bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9015 				  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9016 				  struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg);
9017 
9018 /**
9019  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
9020  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9021  * @chandef: the channel definition
9022  * @iftype: interface type
9023  *
9024  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9025  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9026  */
9027 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9028 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9029 			struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9030 			enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9031 {
9032 	struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9033 		.iftype = iftype,
9034 	};
9035 
9036 	return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9037 }
9038 
9039 /**
9040  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
9041  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9042  * @chandef: the channel definition
9043  * @iftype: interface type
9044  *
9045  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9046  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
9047  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
9048  * more permissive conditions.
9049  *
9050  * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
9051  */
9052 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9053 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9054 			      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9055 			      enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9056 {
9057 	struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9058 		.iftype = iftype,
9059 		.relax = true,
9060 	};
9061 
9062 	return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9063 }
9064 
9065 /**
9066  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
9067  * @dev: the device which switched channels
9068  * @chandef: the new channel definition
9069  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9070  *
9071  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
9072  * driver context!
9073  */
9074 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9075 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9076 			       unsigned int link_id);
9077 
9078 /**
9079  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
9080  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
9081  * @chandef: the future channel definition
9082  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9083  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
9084  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
9085  *
9086  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
9087  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
9088  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
9089  */
9090 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9091 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9092 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
9093 				       bool quiet);
9094 
9095 /**
9096  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
9097  *
9098  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9099  * @band: band pointer to fill
9100  *
9101  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9102  */
9103 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
9104 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
9105 
9106 /**
9107  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
9108  *
9109  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9110  * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
9111  * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
9112  *
9113  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9114  */
9115 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
9116 					  struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
9117 					  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9118 
9119 /**
9120  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
9121  *
9122  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9123  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
9124  *
9125  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9126  */
9127 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9128 					  u8 *op_class);
9129 
9130 /**
9131  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
9132  *
9133  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9134  *
9135  * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
9136  */
9137 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)9138 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
9139 {
9140 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
9141 }
9142 
9143 /**
9144  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
9145  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
9146  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
9147  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
9148  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
9149  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
9150  * @gfp: allocation flags
9151  *
9152  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
9153  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
9154  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
9155  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
9156  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
9157  */
9158 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
9159 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
9160 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
9161 
9162 /**
9163  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
9164  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
9165  *
9166  * Return: calculated bitrate
9167  */
9168 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
9169 
9170 /**
9171  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
9172  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
9173  *
9174  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
9175  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
9176  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
9177  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
9178  * is unbound from the driver.
9179  *
9180  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9181  */
9182 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9183 
9184 /**
9185  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
9186  * @dev: the netdev to register
9187  *
9188  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9189  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
9190  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
9191  * instead as well.
9192  *
9193  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9194  *
9195  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9196  */
9197 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
9198 
9199 /**
9200  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
9201  * @dev: the netdev to register
9202  *
9203  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9204  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
9205  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
9206  * usable instead as well.
9207  *
9208  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9209  */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)9210 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
9211 {
9212 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
9213 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
9214 #endif
9215 }
9216 
9217 /**
9218  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
9219  * @ies: FT IEs
9220  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
9221  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
9222  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
9223  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
9224  */
9225 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
9226 	const u8 *ies;
9227 	size_t ies_len;
9228 	const u8 *target_ap;
9229 	const u8 *ric_ies;
9230 	size_t ric_ies_len;
9231 };
9232 
9233 /**
9234  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
9235  * @netdev: network device
9236  * @ft_event: IE information
9237  */
9238 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9239 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
9240 
9241 /**
9242  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
9243  * @ies: the input IE buffer
9244  * @len: the input length
9245  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
9246  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9247  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9248  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9249  *
9250  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9251  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9252  *
9253  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9254  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9255  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9256  */
9257 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9258 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9259 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9260 
9261 /**
9262  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9263  * @ies: the IE buffer
9264  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9265  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9266  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9267  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9268  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9269  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9270  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9271  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9272  *
9273  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9274  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9275  * split.
9276  *
9277  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9278  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9279  *
9280  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9281  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9282  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9283  *
9284  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9285  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9286  * used.
9287  */
9288 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9289 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9290 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9291 			      size_t offset);
9292 
9293 /**
9294  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9295  * @ies: the IE buffer
9296  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9297  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9298  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9299  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9300  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9301  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9302  *
9303  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9304  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9305  * split.
9306  *
9307  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9308  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9309  *
9310  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9311  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9312  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9313  *
9314  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9315  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9316  * used.
9317  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9318 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9319 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9320 {
9321 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9322 }
9323 
9324 /**
9325  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9326  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9327  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9328  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9329  *
9330  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9331  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9332  * accordingly.
9333  */
9334 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9335 
9336 /**
9337  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9338  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9339  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9340  * @gfp: allocation flags
9341  *
9342  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9343  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9344  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9345  * else caused the wakeup.
9346  */
9347 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9348 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9349 				   gfp_t gfp);
9350 
9351 /**
9352  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9353  *
9354  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9355  * @gfp: allocation flags
9356  *
9357  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9358  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9359  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9360  */
9361 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9362 
9363 /**
9364  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9365  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9366  *
9367  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9368  */
9369 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9370 
9371 /**
9372  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9373  *
9374  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9375  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9376  *
9377  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9378  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9379  * the interface combinations.
9380  *
9381  * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9382  */
9383 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9384 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9385 
9386 /**
9387  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9388  *
9389  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9390  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9391  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9392  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9393  *
9394  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9395  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9396  * purposes.
9397  *
9398  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9399  */
9400 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9401 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9402 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9403 					    void *data),
9404 			       void *data);
9405 
9406 /**
9407  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9408  *
9409  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9410  * @wdev: wireless device
9411  * @gfp: context flags
9412  *
9413  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9414  * disconnected.
9415  *
9416  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9417  */
9418 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9419 			 gfp_t gfp);
9420 
9421 /**
9422  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9423  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9424  *
9425  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9426  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9427  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9428  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9429  *
9430  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9431  * the driver while the function is running.
9432  */
9433 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9434 
9435 /**
9436  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9437  *
9438  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9439  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9440  *
9441  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9442  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9443  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9444 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9445 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9446 {
9447 	u8 *ft_byte;
9448 
9449 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9450 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9451 }
9452 
9453 /**
9454  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9455  *
9456  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9457  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9458  *
9459  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9460  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9461  *
9462  * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9463  */
9464 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9465 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9466 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9467 {
9468 	u8 ft_byte;
9469 
9470 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9471 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9472 }
9473 
9474 /**
9475  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9476  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9477  *
9478  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9479  */
9480 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9481 
9482 /**
9483  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9484  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9485  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9486  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9487  *	 result.
9488  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9489  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9490  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9491  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9492  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9493  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9494  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9495  */
9496 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9497 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9498 	u8 inst_id;
9499 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9500 	const u8 *addr;
9501 	u8 info_len;
9502 	const u8 *info;
9503 	u64 cookie;
9504 };
9505 
9506 /**
9507  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9508  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9509  * @match: match notification parameters
9510  * @gfp: allocation flags
9511  *
9512  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9513  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9514  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9515  */
9516 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9517 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9518 
9519 /**
9520  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9521  *
9522  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9523  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9524  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9525  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9526  * @gfp: allocation flags
9527  *
9528  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9529  */
9530 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9531 				  u8 inst_id,
9532 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9533 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9534 
9535 /* ethtool helper */
9536 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9537 
9538 /**
9539  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9540  * @netdev: network device
9541  * @params: External authentication parameters
9542  * @gfp: allocation flags
9543  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9544  */
9545 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9546 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9547 				   gfp_t gfp);
9548 
9549 /**
9550  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9551  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9552  * @req: the original measurement request
9553  * @result: the result data
9554  * @gfp: allocation flags
9555  */
9556 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9557 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9558 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9559 			  gfp_t gfp);
9560 
9561 /**
9562  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9563  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9564  * @req: the original measurement request
9565  * @gfp: allocation flags
9566  *
9567  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9568  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9569  */
9570 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9571 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9572 			    gfp_t gfp);
9573 
9574 /**
9575  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9576  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9577  * @iftype: interface type
9578  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9579  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9580  *
9581  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9582  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9583  * check_swif is '1'.
9584  *
9585  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9586  */
9587 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9588 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9589 
9590 
9591 /**
9592  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9593  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9594  * @netdev: network device
9595  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9596  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9597  *
9598  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9599  */
9600 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9601 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9602 
9603 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9604 
9605 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9606 
9607 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9608 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9609 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9610 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9611 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9612 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9613 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9614 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9615 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9616 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9617 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9618 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9619 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9620 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9621 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9622 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9623 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9624 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9625 
9626 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9627 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9628 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9629 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9630 
9631 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9632 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9633 
9634 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9635 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9636 
9637 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9638 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9639 #else
9640 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9641 ({									\
9642 	if (0)								\
9643 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9644 	0;								\
9645 })
9646 #endif
9647 
9648 /*
9649  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9650  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9651  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9652  */
9653 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9654 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9655 
9656 /**
9657  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9658  * @netdev: network device
9659  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9660  * @gfp: allocation flags
9661  */
9662 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9663 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9664 				    gfp_t gfp);
9665 
9666 /**
9667  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9668  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9669  */
9670 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9671 
9672 /**
9673  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9674  * @dev: network device
9675  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9676  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9677  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9678  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9679  *
9680  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9681  */
9682 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9683 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9684 			      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9685 
9686 /**
9687  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9688  * @dev: network device
9689  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9690  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9691  *
9692  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9693  */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9694 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9695 						       u64 color_bitmap,
9696 						       u8 link_id)
9697 {
9698 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9699 					 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9700 }
9701 
9702 /**
9703  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9704  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9705  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9706  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9707  *
9708  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9709  *
9710  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9711  */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9712 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9713 						       u8 count, u8 link_id)
9714 {
9715 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9716 					 count, 0, link_id);
9717 }
9718 
9719 /**
9720  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9721  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9722  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9723  *
9724  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9725  *
9726  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9727  */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9728 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9729 						       u8 link_id)
9730 {
9731 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9732 					 0, 0, link_id);
9733 }
9734 
9735 /**
9736  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9737  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9738  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9739  *
9740  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9741  *
9742  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9743  */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9744 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9745 					       u8 link_id)
9746 {
9747 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9748 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9749 					 0, 0, link_id);
9750 }
9751 
9752 /**
9753  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9754  * @dev: network device.
9755  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9756  *
9757  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9758  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9759  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9760  * case disconnect instead.
9761  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9762  */
9763 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9764 
9765 /**
9766  * struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data - MLO reconfiguration data
9767  * @buf: MLO Reconfiguration Response frame (header + body)
9768  * @len: length of the frame data
9769  * @added_links: BIT mask of links successfully added to the association
9770  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID
9771  * @links.bss: the BSS that MLO reconfiguration was requested for, ownership of
9772  *      the pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to
9773  *      cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done().
9774  *
9775  * The BSS pointer must be set for each link for which 'add' operation was
9776  * requested in the assoc_ml_reconf callback.
9777  */
9778 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data {
9779 	const u8 *buf;
9780 	size_t len;
9781 	u16 added_links;
9782 	struct {
9783 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
9784 		u8 *addr;
9785 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
9786 };
9787 
9788 /**
9789  * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done - Notify about MLO reconfiguration result
9790  * @dev: network device.
9791  * @data: MLO reconfiguration done data, &struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data
9792  *
9793  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace that processing of ML reconfiguration
9794  * request to add links to the association is done.
9795  */
9796 void cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(struct net_device *dev,
9797 				  struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data *data);
9798 
9799 /**
9800  * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9801  * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9802  *
9803  * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9804  * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9805  * hold anymore.
9806  */
9807 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9808 
9809 /**
9810  * cfg80211_epcs_changed - Notify about a change in EPCS state
9811  * @netdev: the wireless device whose EPCS state changed
9812  * @enabled: set to true if EPCS was enabled, otherwise set to false.
9813  */
9814 void cfg80211_epcs_changed(struct net_device *netdev, bool enabled);
9815 
9816 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9817 /**
9818  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9819  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9820  * @file: the file being read
9821  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9822  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9823  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9824  * @count: read count
9825  * @ppos: read position
9826  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9827  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9828  *
9829  * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9830  */
9831 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9832 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9833 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9834 				  loff_t *ppos,
9835 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9836 						     struct file *file,
9837 						     char *buf,
9838 						     size_t bufsize,
9839 						     void *data),
9840 				  void *data);
9841 
9842 /**
9843  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9844  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9845  * @file: the file being written to
9846  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9847  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9848  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9849  * @count: read count
9850  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9851  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9852  *
9853  * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9854  */
9855 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9856 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9857 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9858 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9859 						      struct file *file,
9860 						      char *buf,
9861 						      size_t count,
9862 						      void *data),
9863 				   void *data);
9864 #endif
9865 
9866 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9867